blob: fe5eb25076c7fb05881472517f42b1d810a7ce0a [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01005 version 2.0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaufba74ea2018-12-22 11:19:45 +01007 2018/12/22
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100595. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001109.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200111
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010011210. Cache
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010011310.1. Limitation
11410.2. Setup
11510.2.1. Cache section
11610.2.2. Proxy section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117
1181. Quick reminder about HTTP
119----------------------------
120
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100121When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200122fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
123on almost anything found in the contents.
124
125However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
126formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
127correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
128
129
1301.1. The HTTP transaction model
131-------------------------------
132
133The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100134to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
136connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137will involve a new connection :
138
139 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
140
141In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
142establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
143by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
144length.
145
146Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
147to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
148however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
149response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
150header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
151
152 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
153
154Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
155power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
156but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200157a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100159Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
161second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
162page :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
167latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
168correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
169the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100170server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200171
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100172The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
173time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
174are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
175parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
176carry the stream identifier.
177
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100178By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
179connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
180leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100181start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
182processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
183waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200184
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200185HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100186 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
187 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
188 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100189 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200190 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100192For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
193the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100194server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
195is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
196servers.
197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198
1991.2. HTTP request
200-----------------
201
202First, let's consider this HTTP request :
203
204 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100205 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
207 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
208 3 User-agent: my small browser
209 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
210 5 Accept: image/png
211
212
2131.2.1. The Request line
214-----------------------
215
216Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
217
218 - a METHOD : GET
219 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
220 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
221
222All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
223which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
224followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
225is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
226desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
227the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
228
229The URI itself can have several forms :
230
231 - A "relative URI" :
232
233 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234
235 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
236 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
237
238 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
239
240 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241
242 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
243 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
244 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
245 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
246 must accept this form too.
247
248 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
249 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
250 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200252 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
253 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
254 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
255 other protocols too.
256
257In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
258mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
259on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
260It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
261specific to the language, framework or application in use.
262
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100263HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100264assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100265However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
266received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
267processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
268as well as in server logs.
269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200270
2711.2.2. The request headers
272--------------------------
273
274The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
275beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
276an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
277Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
278values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
279encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
280the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
281define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
282
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100283Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200284their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
286as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
288The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
289that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
290is one valid form of empty line.
291
292Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
293headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
294about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
295application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
296
297Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000298 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
300 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
301 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
302
303
3041.3. HTTP response
305------------------
306
307An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
308messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
309
310 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100311 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
313 2 Content-length: 350
314 3 Content-Type: text/html
315
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200316As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
317codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
318response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100319continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
320the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
321following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
322sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
323(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
324correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
325such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
326state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
327over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
328if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
329information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200331
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003321.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333------------------------
334
335Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
336
337 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
338 - a status code : 200
339 - a reason : OK
340
341The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100342 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
343 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
344 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
345 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
346 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000348Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100349"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200350found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
351messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
352or "Authentication Required".
353
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200355
356 Code When / reason
357 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
358 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
359 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
360 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100361 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
362 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363 400 for an invalid or too large request
364 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
365 accessing the stats page)
366 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
367 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
368 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
369 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
370 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
371 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
372 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
373 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
374 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
375
376The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3774.2).
378
379
3801.3.2. The response headers
381---------------------------
382
383Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
384the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
385details.
386
387
3882. Configuring HAProxy
389----------------------
390
3912.1. Configuration file format
392------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200393
394HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
395
396 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
397 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
398 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
399 "frontend" and "backend".
400
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100401The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
402referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200403delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100404
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200405
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004062.2. Quoting and escaping
407-------------------------
408
409HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
410many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
411with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
412single quotes.
413
414If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
415them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
416escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
417
418Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
419
420 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
421 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
422 \\ to use a backslash
423 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
424 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
425
426Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
427the interpretation of:
428
429 space as a parameter separator
430 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
431 # hash as a comment start
432
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200433Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
434-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
435backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
436
437Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200438quoting.
439
440Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
441nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
442
443Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
444equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
445
446 Example:
447 # those are equivalents:
448 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
449 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
450 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
451 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
452 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
453
454 # those are equivalents:
455 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
456 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
457 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
458 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
459
460
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004612.3. Environment variables
462--------------------------
463
464HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
465interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
466configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
467optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
468shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
469underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
470
471 Example:
472
473 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
474
475 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
476
477 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
478
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200479A special variable $HAPROXY_LOCALPEER is defined at the startup of the process
480which contains the name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
481
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200482
4832.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200484----------------
485
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100486Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100487values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
488otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
489numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
490for every keyword. Supported units are :
491
492 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
493 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
494 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
495 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
496 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
497 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
498
499
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005002.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200501-------------
502
503 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
504 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
505 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
506 global
507 daemon
508 maxconn 256
509
510 defaults
511 mode http
512 timeout connect 5000ms
513 timeout client 50000ms
514 timeout server 50000ms
515
516 frontend http-in
517 bind *:80
518 default_backend servers
519
520 backend servers
521 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
522
523
524 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
525 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
526 global
527 daemon
528 maxconn 256
529
530 defaults
531 mode http
532 timeout connect 5000ms
533 timeout client 50000ms
534 timeout server 50000ms
535
536 listen http-in
537 bind *:80
538 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
539
540
541Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
542
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100543 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200544
545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200547--------------------
548
549Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
550are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
551of them have command-line equivalents.
552
553The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
554
555 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200556 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200557 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200558 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200559 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200560 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200561 - description
562 - deviceatlas-json-file
563 - deviceatlas-log-level
564 - deviceatlas-separator
565 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900566 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200567 - gid
568 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100569 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200570 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200571 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100572 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200573 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200575 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200576 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200577 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100578 - presetenv
579 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200580 - uid
581 - ulimit-n
582 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100583 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200584 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200585 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200586 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200587 - ssl-default-bind-options
588 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200589 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - ssl-default-server-options
591 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100592 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100593 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100594 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100595 - 51degrees-data-file
596 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200597 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200598 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100599 - wurfl-data-file
600 - wurfl-information-list
601 - wurfl-information-list-separator
602 - wurfl-engine-mode
603 - wurfl-cache-size
604 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100605
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200606 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200607 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200608 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200609 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100610 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100611 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100612 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200613 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200614 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200615 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200616 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200617 - noepoll
618 - nokqueue
619 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100620 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300621 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000622 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100623 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200624 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200625 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200626 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000627 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000628 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - tune.buffers.limit
630 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200631 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200632 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100633 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200634 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200635 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200636 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100637 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200638 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200639 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100640 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100641 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100642 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100643 - tune.lua.session-timeout
644 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200645 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100646 - tune.maxaccept
647 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200648 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200649 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200650 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100651 - tune.rcvbuf.client
652 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100653 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200654 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100655 - tune.sndbuf.client
656 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100657 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100658 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200659 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100660 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200661 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200662 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100663 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200664 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100665 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200666 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
667 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
668 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100669 - tune.zlib.memlevel
670 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672 * Debugging
673 - debug
674 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675
676
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006773.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200678------------------------------------
679
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200680ca-base <dir>
681 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200682 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
683 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200685chroot <jail dir>
686 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
687 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
688 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
689 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
690 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100691 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100692
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100693cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
694 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
695 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
696 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
697 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
698 set. These sets have the format
699
700 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
701
702 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100703 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100704 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
705 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100706 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
707 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100708 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100709 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100710 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100711 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100712 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
713 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
714 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
715 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100717 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
718 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
719 on the machine's word size.
720
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100721 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100722 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
723 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
724 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
725 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
726 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
727 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100728
729 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100730 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
731
732 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
733 # first 4 CPUs
734
735 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
736 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
737 # word size.
738
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100739 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100740 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100741 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
742 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
743 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
744
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100745 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
746 # and so on.
747 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
748 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
749 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
750
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100752 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
753 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
754 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
755
756 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
757 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
758 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
759
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
761 # and a thread range.
762 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
763 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
764 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
765
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200766crt-base <dir>
767 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
768 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
769 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
770
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200771daemon
772 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
773 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100774 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
775 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200777deviceatlas-json-file <path>
778 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100779 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200780
781deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100782 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200783 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
784
785deviceatlas-separator <char>
786 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
787 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
788
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100789deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200790 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
791 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
792 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100793
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900794external-check
795 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
796 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
797 See "option external-check".
798
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200799gid <number>
800 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
801 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
802 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100803 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
804 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200805 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100806
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100807hard-stop-after <time>
808 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
809
810 Arguments :
811 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
812 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
813 SIGUSR1 signal.
814
815 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
816 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
817 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
818
819 Example:
820 global
821 hard-stop-after 30s
822
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200823group <group name>
824 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
825 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100826
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200827log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100828 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100829 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100830 configured with "log global".
831
832 <address> can be one of:
833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100834 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100835 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
836 port).
837
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100838 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
839 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
840 port).
841
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100842 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100843 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
844 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100845 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100846
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100847 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
848 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
849 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
850 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
851 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
852 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
853 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
854 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
855 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
856 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
857 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
858 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
859 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
860 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100861 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
862 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +0100863
864 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
865 "fd@2", see above.
866
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200867 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
868 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100869
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200870 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
871 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
872 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
873 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
874 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
875 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
876 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
877 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
878 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
879 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100880 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
881 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200882
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200883 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
884 one of the following :
885
886 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
887 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
888
889 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
890 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
891
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100892 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
893 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
894 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
895 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
896 logger consumes.
897
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100898 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
899 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
900 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
901 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
902
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100903 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200904
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +0100905 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
906 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
907 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
908
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +0100909 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
910 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
911 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
912 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200913
914 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200915 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
916 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
917 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
918 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
919 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
920 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200921
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200922 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200923
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100924log-send-hostname [<string>]
925 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
926 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
927 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
928 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
929 the logs.
930
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000931log-tag <string>
932 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
933 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
934 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100935 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000936
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100937lua-load <file>
938 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
939 used multiple times.
940
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100941master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200942 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
943 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
944 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100945 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200946 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
947 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100948 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
949 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
950 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
951 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
952 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200953
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +0100954 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200955
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200956nbproc <number>
957 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
958 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
959 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
960 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100961 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
962 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200963
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200964nbthread <number>
965 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
966 creates <number> threads for each created processes. It means if HAProxy is
967 started in foreground, it only creates <number> threads for the first
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +0100968 process. See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100971 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
973 starting the process. See also "daemon".
974
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100975presetenv <name> <value>
976 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
977 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
978 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
979 and "unsetenv".
980
981resetenv [<name> ...]
982 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
983 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
984 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
985 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
986 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
987 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
988 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
989 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
990
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100991stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200992 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
993 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
994 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
995 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
996 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
997 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100998 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100999 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1000 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1001 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1002 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001003
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001004server-state-base <directory>
1005 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001006 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1007 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001008
1009server-state-file <file>
1010 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1011 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1012 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1013 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1014 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1015 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1016 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1017 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001018 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1019 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001020
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001021setenv <name> <value>
1022 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1023 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1024 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1025 and "unsetenv".
1026
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001027ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1028 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1029 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001030 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 for all
1031 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
1032 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance
1033 a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). For
1034 TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites"
1035 keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1036
1037ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1038 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1039 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1040 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1041 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1042 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1043 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites", and can
1044 be for instance a string such as
1045 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
1046 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
1047 the "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
1048 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001049
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001050ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1051 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1052 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1053 keyword to see available options.
1054
1055 Example:
1056 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001057 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001058
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001059ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1061 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001062 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3 with the server,
1063 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
1064 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration,
1065 please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the
1066 "server" keyword for more information.
1067
1068ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1069 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1070 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1071 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1072 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1073 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
1074 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration for
1075 TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword.
1076 Please check the "server" keyword for more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001077
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001078ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1079 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1080 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1081 keyword to see available options.
1082
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001083ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1084 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1085 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1086 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001087 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001088 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001089 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1090 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1091 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1092 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001093 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1094 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1095 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1096
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001097ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1098 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1099 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1100 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1101
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001102stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1103 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1104 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1105 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001106 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001107 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001108
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001109 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1110 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1111 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001112
1113stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1114 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1115 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001116 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001117
1118stats maxconn <connections>
1119 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1120 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122uid <number>
1123 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1124 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1125 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1126 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1127
1128ulimit-n <number>
1129 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1130 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1131 option.
1132
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001133unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1134 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1135
1136 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1137 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1138 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1139 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1140 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1141 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1142 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1143 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1144 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1145 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1146
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001147unsetenv [<name> ...]
1148 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1149 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1150 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1151 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1152 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1153 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1154 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1155
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001156user <user name>
1157 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1158 See also "uid" and "group".
1159
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001160node <name>
1161 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1162
1163 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1164 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1165 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1166 traffic.
1167
1168description <text>
1169 Add a text that describes the instance.
1170
1171 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1172 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1173 "<" and ">" characters.
1174
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100117551degrees-data-file <file path>
1176 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001177 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001178
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001179 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001180 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1181
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000118251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001183 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1184 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1185 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1186
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001187 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001188 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1189
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200119051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001191 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1192 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1193
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001194 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1195 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1196
119751degrees-cache-size <number>
1198 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1199 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1200 By default, this cache is disabled.
1201
1202 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001203 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1204
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001205wurfl-data-file <file path>
1206 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1207 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1208
1209 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1210 with USE_WURFL=1.
1211
1212wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1213 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1214 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1215 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1216
1217 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1218
1219 Valid WURFL properties are:
1220 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1221
1222 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1223 device.
1224
1225 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1226 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1227
1228 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1229 particular web request.
1230
1231 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1232 used Libwurfl API version.
1233
1234 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1235 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1236 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1237
1238 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1239 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1240
1241 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1242 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1243
1244 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1245
1246 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1247
1248 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1249 with USE_WURFL=1.
1250
1251wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1252 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1253 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1254
1255 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1256 with USE_WURFL=1.
1257
1258wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1259 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1260 thus before the chroot.
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1263 with USE_WURFL=1.
1264
1265wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1266 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1267 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001268 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001269 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001270 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001271 mode is enabled by default.
1272
1273 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1274 with USE_WURFL=1.
1275
1276wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1277 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1278 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1279 - "0" : no cache is used.
1280 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1281 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1282 the highest performing option.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1285 with USE_WURFL=1.
1286
1287wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1288 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1289 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1292 with USE_WURFL=1.
1293
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012953.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001296-----------------------
1297
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001298busy-polling
1299 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1300 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1301 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1302 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1303 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1304 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1305 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1306 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1307 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1308 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1309 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1310 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1311 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1312 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1313 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1314 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1315 "poll" pollers.
1316
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001317max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1318 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1319 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1320 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1321 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1322 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1323 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1324 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1325 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1326
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001327maxconn <number>
1328 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1329 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1330 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001331 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1332 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1333 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1334 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001335 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1336 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1337 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1338 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1339 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001340
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001341maxconnrate <number>
1342 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1343 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1344 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1345 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1346 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1347 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1348 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1349 fairness.
1350
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001351maxcomprate <number>
1352 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001353 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001354 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1355 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1356 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001357 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001358 default value.
1359
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001360maxcompcpuusage <number>
1361 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1362 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1363 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1364 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1365 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1366 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1367 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1368 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1369
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001370maxpipes <number>
1371 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1372 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1373 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1374 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1375 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1376 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1377
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001378maxsessrate <number>
1379 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1380 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1381 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1382 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1383 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1384 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1385 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1386 fairness.
1387
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001388maxsslconn <number>
1389 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1390 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1391 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1392 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1393 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1394 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1395 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001396 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1397 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1398 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1399 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1400 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1401 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1402 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001403
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001404maxsslrate <number>
1405 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1406 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1407 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1408 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1409 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1410 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1411 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1412 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1413 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1414 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1415
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001416maxzlibmem <number>
1417 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1418 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1419 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001420 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1421 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1422 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1423
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001424noepoll
1425 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1426 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001427 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001428
1429nokqueue
1430 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1431 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1432 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1433
1434nopoll
1435 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1436 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001437 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001438 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001440nosplice
1441 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001442 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001443 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001444 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001445 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1446 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1447 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1448 "option splice-response".
1449
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450nogetaddrinfo
1451 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1452 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1453
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001454noreuseport
1455 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1456 command line argument "-dR".
1457
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001458profiling.tasks { on | off }
1459 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. CPU profiling per
1460 task can be very convenient to report where the time is spent and which
1461 requests have what effect on which other request. It is not enabled by
1462 default as it may consume a little bit extra CPU. This requires a system
1463 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1464 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1465 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1466 CLI.
1467
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001468spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001469 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1470 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1471 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1472 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1473 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1474 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001475
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001476ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001477 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001478 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001479 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1480 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1481 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1482 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1483 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1485 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001486 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1487 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1488 openssl configuration file uses:
1489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1490
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001491ssl-mode-async
1492 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001493 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001494 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1495 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1496 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
1497 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and reneg
1498 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001499
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001500tune.buffers.limit <number>
1501 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1502 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1503 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1504 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1505 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001506 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001507 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1508 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1509 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1510 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1511 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1512 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1513 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1514 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1515 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1516
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001517tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1518 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1519 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1520 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1521 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1522
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001523tune.bufsize <number>
1524 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1525 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1526 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1527 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1528 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1529 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1530 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001531 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1532 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1533 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001534 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001535 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1536 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1537 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001538
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001539tune.chksize <number>
1540 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1541 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1542 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1543 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1544 checks whenever possible.
1545
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001546tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1547 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1548 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1549 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1550 this value. The default value is 1.
1551
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001552tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1553 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1554 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1555 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1556 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1557 change it.
1558
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001559tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1560 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001561 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1562 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001563 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1564 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1565 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1566 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1567 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1568
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001569tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1570 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1571 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1572 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1573 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1574 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1575 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1576 recommended not to change this value.
1577
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001578tune.http.cookielen <number>
1579 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1580 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1581 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1582 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1583 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1584 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1585 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1586 to change this value.
1587
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001588tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001589 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1590 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001591 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001592 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001593 configuration directives too.
1594 The default value is 1024.
1595
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001596tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1597 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1598 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1599 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1600 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1601 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1602 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001603 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1604 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1605 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001606
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001607tune.idletimer <timeout>
1608 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1609 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1610 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1611 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1612 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1613 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001614 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001615 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1616 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1617
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001618tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1619 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001620 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001621 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1622 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001623 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001624 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1625 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1626
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001627tune.lua.maxmem
1628 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1629 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1630 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1631 memory.
1632
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001633tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1634 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001635 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1636 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001637 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001638
1639tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1640 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1641 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1642 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1643 check servers.
1644
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001645tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1646 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1647 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1648 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001649 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001650
Olivier Houcharddc21ff72019-01-29 15:20:16 +01001651tune.fail-alloc
1652 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1653 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1654 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1655 gracefully.
1656
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001657tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001658 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1659 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1660 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1661 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1662 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1663 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1664 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1665 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1666 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1667 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001668
1669tune.maxpollevents <number>
1670 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1671 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1672 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1673 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1674 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1675
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001676tune.maxrewrite <number>
1677 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1678 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1679 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1680 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1681 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1682 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1683 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1684 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1685 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1686 bufsize.
1687
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001688tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1689 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1690 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1691 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1692 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1693 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1694 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1695 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1696 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1697 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1698 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1699 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1700 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1701 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1702 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1703 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1704 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1705 setting this parameter to 0.
1706
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001707tune.pipesize <number>
1708 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1709 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1710 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1711 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1712 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1713 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1714
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001715tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1716tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1717 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1718 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1719 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1720 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001721 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001722 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1723 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1724
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001725tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001726 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001727 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1728 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1729 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1730 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1731
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001732tune.runqueue-depth <number>
1733 Sets the maxinum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
1734 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
1735 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead.
1736
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001737tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1738tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1739 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1740 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1741 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1742 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001743 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001744 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1745 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1746 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1747 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1748 notifying haproxy again.
1749
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001750tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001751 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1752 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1753 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001754 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001755 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001756 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001757 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1758 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1759 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001760 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1761 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001762
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001763tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02001764 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001765 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1766 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1767 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1768 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1769 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1770
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001771tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1772 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001773 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001774 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1775 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1776 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1777 being used for too long.
1778
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001779tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1780 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1781 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1782 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1783 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1784 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1785 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1786 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1787 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1788 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1789 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001790 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001791 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001792
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001793tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1794 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1795 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1796 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1797 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1798 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1799 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1800 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001801 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1802 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001803
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001804tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1805 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1806 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1807 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1808 1000 entries.
1809
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001810tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1811 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1812 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1813 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1814
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001815tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001816tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001817tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1818tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1819tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001820 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1821 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1822 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1823 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1824 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1825 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1826 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1827 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001828
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001829 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1830 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1831 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1832 all available space is consumed.
1833 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1834 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1835 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001836
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001837tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1838 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001839 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001840 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001841 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001842 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1843
1844tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1845 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1846 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001847 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1848 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001849
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018503.3. Debugging
1851--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001852
1853debug
1854 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1855 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1856 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1857 system startup.
1858
1859quiet
1860 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1861 line argument "-q".
1862
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001863
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010018643.4. Userlists
1865--------------
1866It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1867http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1868it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1869
1870userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001871 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001872 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1873
1874group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001875 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001876 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1877 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1878
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001879user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1880 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001881 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1882 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001883 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
1884 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
1885 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
1886 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001887
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01001888 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
1889 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
1890 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
1891 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
1892 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
1893 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
1894 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
1895 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
1896 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001897
1898 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001899 userlist L1
1900 group G1 users tiger,scott
1901 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001902
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001903 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1904 user scott insecure-password elgato
1905 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001906
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001907 userlist L2
1908 group G1
1909 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001910
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001911 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1912 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1913 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001914
1915 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001916
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001917
19183.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001919----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001920It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1921several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1922instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1923values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1924automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1925In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1926using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1927tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1928reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1929Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1930that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1931each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001932
1933peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001934 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001935 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1936
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001937bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
1938 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
1939 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
1940
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001941disabled
1942 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1943 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1944 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1945
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001946default-bind [param*]
1947 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
1948
1949default-server [param*]
1950 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
1951
1952 Arguments:
1953 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
1954 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
1955 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
1956 details.
1957
1958
1959 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
1960
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001961enable
1962 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1963
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001964peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001965 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1966 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1967 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1968 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1969 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1970 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1971
1972 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1973 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1974
1975 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1976 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1977 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1978 across all peers.
1979
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001980 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1981 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001982
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001983 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
1984 "server" keyword explanation below).
1985
1986server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
1987 As previously mentionned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
1988 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
1989 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
1990 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
1991 of this "peers" section).
1992 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
1993
1994
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001995 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01001996 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001997 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001998 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1999 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2000 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002001
2002 backend mybackend
2003 mode tcp
2004 balance roundrobin
2005 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2006 stick on src
2007
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002008 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2009 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002010
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002011 Example:
2012 peers mypeers
2013 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2014 default-server ssl verify none
2015 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2016 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002017
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090020183.6. Mailers
2019------------
2020It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2021If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2022in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2023
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002024mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002025 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2026 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2027
2028mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2029 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2030
2031 Example:
2032 mailers mymailers
2033 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2034 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2035
2036 backend mybackend
2037 mode tcp
2038 balance roundrobin
2039
2040 email-alert mailers mymailers
2041 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2042 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2043
2044 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2045 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2046
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002047timeout mail <time>
2048 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2049 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2050 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2051 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2052
2053 Example:
2054 mailers mymailers
2055 timeout mail 20s
2056 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002057
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020584. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002059----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002061Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002062 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002063 - frontend <name>
2064 - backend <name>
2065 - listen <name>
2066
2067A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2068its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2069section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002071
2072A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2073connections.
2074
2075A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2076to forward incoming connections.
2077
2078A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2079parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2080
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2082'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2083case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2084
2085Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2086logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2087proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2088However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2089name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2090
2091Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2092and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002093bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002094protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2095modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2096arbitrary criteria.
2097
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002098In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2099a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002100the backend's. HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002101
2102 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2103 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2104 between responses and new requests.
2105
2106 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
2107 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
2108 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002109 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing. It
2110 is supported only on frontends.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002111
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002112 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2113 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2114 client-facing connection remains open.
2115
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002116 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2117 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002118
2119The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2120frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2121following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002122weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002123
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002124 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002125
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002126 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2127 ----+-----+-----+----
2128 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2129 ----+-----+-----+----
2130 TUN | TUN | SCL | CLO
2131 Frontend ----+-----+-----+----
2132 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2133 ----+-----+-----+----
2134 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002136
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002137
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021384.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2139--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002141The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2142limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2143they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2144limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002145marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002146option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002147and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2148with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2149specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002151
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002152 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2153------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2154acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002155appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002156backlog X X X -
2157balance X - X X
2158bind - X X -
2159bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002160block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002161capture cookie - X X -
2162capture request header - X X -
2163capture response header - X X -
2164clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002165compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002166contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2167cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002168declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002169default-server X - X X
2170default_backend X X X -
2171description - X X X
2172disabled X X X X
2173dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002174email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002175email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002176email-alert mailers X X X X
2177email-alert myhostname X X X X
2178email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002179enabled X X X X
2180errorfile X X X X
2181errorloc X X X X
2182errorloc302 X X X X
2183-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2184errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002185force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002186filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002187fullconn X - X X
2188grace X X X X
2189hash-type X - X X
2190http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01002191http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002192http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002193http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002194http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002195http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002196http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002197id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002198ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002199load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002200log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002201log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002202log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002203log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002204max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002205maxconn X X X -
2206mode X X X X
2207monitor fail - X X -
2208monitor-net X X X -
2209monitor-uri X X X -
2210option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2211option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2212option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2213option allbackups (*) X - X X
2214option checkcache (*) X - X X
2215option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2216option contstats (*) X X X -
2217option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2218option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002219option forceclose (deprectated) (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002220-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2221option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002222option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002223option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002224option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002225option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002226option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002227option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02002228option http-tunnel (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002229option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02002230option http-use-htx (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002231option httpchk X - X X
2232option httpclose (*) X X X X
2233option httplog X X X X
2234option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002235option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002236option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002237option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002238option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2239option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2240option logasap (*) X X X -
2241option mysql-check X - X X
2242option nolinger (*) X X X X
2243option originalto X X X X
2244option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002245option pgsql-check X - X X
2246option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002247option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002248option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002249option smtpchk X - X X
2250option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2251option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2252option splice-request (*) X X X X
2253option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002254option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002255option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2256option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2257-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002258option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002259option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2260option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2261option tcpka X X X X
2262option tcplog X X X X
2263option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002264external-check command X - X X
2265external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002266persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2267rate-limit sessions X X X -
2268redirect - X X X
2269redisp (deprecated) X - X X
2270redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
2271reqadd - X X X
2272reqallow - X X X
2273reqdel - X X X
2274reqdeny - X X X
2275reqiallow - X X X
2276reqidel - X X X
2277reqideny - X X X
2278reqipass - X X X
2279reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002280reqitarpit - X X X
2281reqpass - X X X
2282reqrep - X X X
2283-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002284reqtarpit - X X X
2285retries X - X X
2286rspadd - X X X
2287rspdel - X X X
2288rspdeny - X X X
2289rspidel - X X X
2290rspideny - X X X
2291rspirep - X X X
2292rsprep - X X X
2293server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002294server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002295server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002296source X - X X
2297srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002298stats admin - X X X
2299stats auth X X X X
2300stats enable X X X X
2301stats hide-version X X X X
2302stats http-request - X X X
2303stats realm X X X X
2304stats refresh X X X X
2305stats scope X X X X
2306stats show-desc X X X X
2307stats show-legends X X X X
2308stats show-node X X X X
2309stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002310-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2311stick match - - X X
2312stick on - - X X
2313stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002314stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002315stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002316tcp-check connect - - X X
2317tcp-check expect - - X X
2318tcp-check send - - X X
2319tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002320tcp-request connection - X X -
2321tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002322tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002323tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002324tcp-response content - - X X
2325tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002326timeout check X - X X
2327timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002328timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002329timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2330timeout connect X - X X
2331timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2332timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2333timeout http-request X X X X
2334timeout queue X - X X
2335timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002336timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002337timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2338timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002339timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002340transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002341unique-id-format X X X -
2342unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002343use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002344use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002345------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2346 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002347
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023494.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2350---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002351
2352This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2353
2354
2355acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2356 Declare or complete an access list.
2357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2358 no | yes | yes | yes
2359 Example:
2360 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2361 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2362 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2363
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002364 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
2366
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002367appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2368 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2371 no | no | yes | yes
2372 Arguments :
2373 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2374 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2375
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002376 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002377 checked in each cookie value.
2378
2379 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2380 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2381 milliseconds.
2382
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002383 request-learn
2384 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2385 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2386 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2387 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2388 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2389 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2390
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002391 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2392 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2393 data following this prefix.
2394
2395 Example :
2396 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2397
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002398 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXX=XXXX,
2399 the appsession value will be XXX=XXXX.
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002400
2401 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2402 2 modes are currently supported :
2403 - path-parameters :
2404 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2405 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2406 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2407 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2408 - query-string :
2409 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2410 query string.
2411
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002412 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2413 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2414 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002415
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002416 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2417 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
2419
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002420backlog <conns>
2421 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2423 yes | yes | yes | no
2424 Arguments :
2425 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2426 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002427 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002428
2429 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2430 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2431 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2432 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2433 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2434 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2435 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2436 backlog parameter.
2437
2438 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2439 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2440 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2441
2442 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2443
2444
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002445balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002446balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002447 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2449 yes | no | yes | yes
2450 Arguments :
2451 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2452 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2453 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2454 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2455
2456 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2457 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2458 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2459 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002460 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002461 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002462 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2463 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2464 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2465 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2466 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2467 it, so that you don't worry.
2468
2469 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2470 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2471 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2472 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2473 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2474 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2475 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2476 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002477
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002478 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2479 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2480 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2481 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2482 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2483 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2484 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2485 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2486
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002487 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002488 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002489 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2490 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002491 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002492 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2493 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2494 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2495 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2496 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002497 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2498 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2499 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2500 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2501 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2502 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002503
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002504 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2505 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2506 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2507 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2508 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2509 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2510 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2511 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002512 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002513 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002514 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2515 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2516 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002517
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002518 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2519 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2520 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2521 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2522 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2523 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2524 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2525 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2526 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2527 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2528 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2529 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002530
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002531 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002532 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2533 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2534 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2535 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2536 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2537 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2538 URIs start with a leading "/".
2539
2540 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2541 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2542 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2543 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2544
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002545 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002546 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2547
2548 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002549 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2550 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002551 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2552 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2553 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2554 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002555 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002556 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2557 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002558
2559 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2560 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2561 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2562 server will receive the request.
2563
2564 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2565 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2566 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2567 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2568 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002569 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2570 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2571 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002572
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002573 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2574 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2575 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2576 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2577 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002579 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002580 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2581 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2582 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2583
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002584 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2585 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2586 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2587
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002588 random
2589 random(<draws>)
2590 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002591 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
2592 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
2593 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
2594 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01002595 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
2596 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
2597 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
2598 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
2599 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
2600 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
2601 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
2602 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
2603 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
2604 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
2605 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
2606 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
2607 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
2608 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
2609 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
2610 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
2611 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
2612 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
2613 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
2614 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02002615
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002616 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002617 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002618 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2619 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2620 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2621 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2622 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2623 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002624 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002625 used instead.
2626
2627 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2628 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2629 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2630 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2631
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002632 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2633 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2634 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2635
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002636 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002639 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2640 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002641
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002642 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2643 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2644 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002645
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02002646 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
2647 based alghoritms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
2648 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
2649 NTLM relies on.
2650
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651 Examples :
2652 balance roundrobin
2653 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002654 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002655 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2656 balance hdr(host)
2657 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002658
2659 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2660 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2661
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002662 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002663 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2664 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2665 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2666 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2667
2668 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2669 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2670 defaults to 16 kB.
2671
2672 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2673 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2674
2675 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2676 Round Robin.
2677
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002678 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002679 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2680 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2681 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2682
2683 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2684
2685 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002686 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002687 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2688 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2689 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002690
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002691 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002692
2693
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002694bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2695bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002696 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2697 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2698 no | yes | yes | no
2699 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002700 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2701 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2702 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2703 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002704 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002705 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2706 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2707 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2708 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2709 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2710 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2711 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002712 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2713 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2714 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2715 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2716 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2717 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2718 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002719 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2720 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2721 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02002722 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
2723 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
2724 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
2725 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002726 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2727 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2728 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002729
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002730 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2731 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002732 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2733 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2734 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002735 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2736 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2737 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2738 the range.
2739
2740 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2741 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2742 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2743 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2744 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2745 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2746 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002747 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002748 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002750 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002751 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002752 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2753 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2754 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2755 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2756 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2757 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2758
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002759 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2760 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2761 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2762 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002763
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002764 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2765 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2766 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2767 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2768 in a frontend.
2769
2770 Example :
2771 listen http_proxy
2772 bind :80,:443
2773 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002774 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002775
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002776 listen http_https_proxy
2777 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002778 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002779
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002780 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2781 bind ipv6@:80
2782 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2783 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2784
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002785 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002786 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002787
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002788 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2789 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2790 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2791 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2792 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2793
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002794 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002795 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
2797
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002798bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002799 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2801 yes | yes | yes | yes
2802 Arguments :
2803 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2804 may be used to override a default value.
2805
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002806 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002807 option may be combined with other numbers.
2808
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002809 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002810 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2811 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2812 missing from all processes.
2813
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002814 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002815 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01002816 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
2817 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
2818 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
2819 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
2820 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002821 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002822
2823 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2824 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2825 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2826 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2827 and 'even' instances.
2828
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002829 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2830 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2831 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2832 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002833
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002834 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2835 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2836
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002837 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2838 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2839 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2840
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002841 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2842 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2843
2844 Example :
2845 listen app_ip1
2846 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002847 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002848
2849 listen app_ip2
2850 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002851 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002852
2853 listen management
2854 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002855 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002856
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002857 listen management
2858 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2859 bind-process 1-4
2860
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002861 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002862
2863
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002864block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002865 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2867 no | yes | yes | yes
2868
2869 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2870 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002871 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002872 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002873 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002874 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2875 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2876 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002877
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002878 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2879 "http-request deny" instead.
2880
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002881 Example:
2882 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2883 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2884 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002885 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2886 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2887 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002889 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2890 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2891 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002892
2893capture cookie <name> len <length>
2894 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2896 no | yes | yes | no
2897 Arguments :
2898 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2899 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2900 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2901 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002902 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002903
2904 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2905 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2906 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2907 right if it exceeds <length>.
2908
2909 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2910 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2911 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2912 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2913
2914 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2915 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2916 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2917
2918 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2919 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2920 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002921 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2922 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2923 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002924
2925 Example:
2926 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2927
2928 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002929 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930
2931
2932capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002933 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2935 no | yes | yes | no
2936 Arguments :
2937 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002938 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002939 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2940 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2941 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2942
2943 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2944 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2945 it exceeds <length>.
2946
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002947 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002948 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2949 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002950 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2951 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2952 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2953 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002954 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002955 environments to find where the request came from.
2956
2957 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2958 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2959 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2960 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002961
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002962 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2963 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2964 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2965 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2966 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002967
2968 Example:
2969 capture request header Host len 15
2970 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002971 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002972
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002973 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002974 about logging.
2975
2976
2977capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002978 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2980 no | yes | yes | no
2981 Arguments :
2982 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002983 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2985 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2986 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2987
2988 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2989 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2990 it exceeds <length>.
2991
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002992 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002993 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2994 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2995 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002996 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2997 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2998 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2999 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003000
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003001 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3002 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3003 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3004 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3005 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003006
3007 Example:
3008 capture response header Content-length len 9
3009 capture response header Location len 15
3010
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003011 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003012 about logging.
3013
3014
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003015clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003016 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3018 yes | yes | yes | no
3019 Arguments :
3020 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3021 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3022 as explained at the top of this document.
3023
3024 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
3025 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
3026 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
3027 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
3028 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
3029 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
3030 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
3031 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003032 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003033 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003034 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003035
3036 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
3037 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3038 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3039 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3040 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
3041 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3042
3043 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
3044 Please use "timeout client" instead.
3045
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01003046 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
3047 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003048
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003049compression algo <algorithm> ...
3050compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003051compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003052 Enable HTTP compression.
3053 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3054 yes | yes | yes | yes
3055 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003056 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3057 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3058 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3059
3060 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003061 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3062 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3063 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003064
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003065 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003066 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003067
3068 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3069 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3070 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3071 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3072 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003073 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003074
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003075 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3076 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3077 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3078 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3079 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3080 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3081 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003082 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003083
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003084 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003085 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003086 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3087 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3088 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3089 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3090 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003091
3092 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3093 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3094 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3095 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3096 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003097 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3098 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3099 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3100 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3101 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003102 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3103 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003104
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003105 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003106 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3107 "Accept-Encoding" header
3108 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003109 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003110 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3111 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3112 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3113 "multipart"
3114 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3115 header
3116 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3117 and later
3118 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3119 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003120 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003121
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003122 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003123
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003124 Examples :
3125 compression algo gzip
3126 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003127
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003128
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003129contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003130 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3132 yes | no | yes | yes
3133 Arguments :
3134 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
3135 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3136 as explained at the top of this document.
3137
3138 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003139 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01003140 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003141 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003142 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
3143 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
3144 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
3145
3146 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
3147 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
3148 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
3149 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
3150 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
3151 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
3152
3153 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
3154 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
3155 instead.
3156
3157 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
3158 "timeout server", "contimeout".
3159
3160
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003161cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003162 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3163 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003164 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003165 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3167 yes | no | yes | yes
3168 Arguments :
3169 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3170 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3171 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3172 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3173 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3174 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003175 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003176 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3177 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3178
3179 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3180 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3181 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3182 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3183 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3184 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003185 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3186 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003187 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003188 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3189 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
3191 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003192 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003193
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003194 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003195 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
3196 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003197 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003198 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3199 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3200 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3201 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3202 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3203 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3204 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003205
3206 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3207 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3208 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3209 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3210 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3211 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3212 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3213 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3214 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003215 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003216 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3217 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3218 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003219
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003220 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3221 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3222 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003223 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3224 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3225 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3226 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003227 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3228 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3229 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003230
3231 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3232 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3233 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3234 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3235 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3236 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3237 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3238 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3239 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3240
3241 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3242 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3243 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3244 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3245 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3246 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3247 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3248 persistence cookie in the cache.
3249 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3250
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003251 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3252 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3253 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3254 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3255 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003256 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003257 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3258 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3259 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3260 they logout.
3261
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003262 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3263 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3264 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3265 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3266
3267 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3268 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3269 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3270 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3271 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3272 this attribute.
3273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003274 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003275 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003276 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3277 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3278 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3279 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3280 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3281 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003282
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003283 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3284 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3285 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3286 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3287 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3288 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3289 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3290 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003291 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003292 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3293 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3294 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3295 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3296 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3297 the site.
3298
3299 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3300 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3301 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3302 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3303 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3304 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3305 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3306 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3307 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3308 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3309 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3310 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3311 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003312 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003313 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3314 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3315
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003316 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3317 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3318 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3319 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3320 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3321 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003323 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3324 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3325 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3326 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003327
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003328 Examples :
3329 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3330 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3331 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003332 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003333
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003334 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003335
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003336
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003337declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3338 Declares a capture slot.
3339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3340 no | yes | yes | no
3341 Arguments:
3342 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3343
3344 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3345 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3346 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3347 for use in the response.
3348
3349 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003350 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003351 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3352
3353
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003354default-server [param*]
3355 Change default options for a server in a backend
3356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3357 yes | no | yes | yes
3358 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003359 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3360 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3361 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3362 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003363
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003364 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003365 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3366
3367 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003369
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003370default_backend <backend>
3371 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3372 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3373 yes | yes | yes | no
3374 Arguments :
3375 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3376
3377 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3378 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3379 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3380 will catch all undetermined requests.
3381
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003382 Example :
3383
3384 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3385 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3386 default_backend dynamic
3387
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003388 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003390
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003391description <string>
3392 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3394 no | yes | yes | yes
3395 Arguments : string
3396
3397 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3398 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3399 it describes.
3400 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3401
3402
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003403disabled
3404 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3406 yes | yes | yes | yes
3407 Arguments : none
3408
3409 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3410 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3411 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3412 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3413 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3414 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3415 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3416
3417 See also : "enabled"
3418
3419
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003420dispatch <address>:<port>
3421 Set a default server address
3422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3423 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003424 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003425
3426 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3427 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3428 during start-up.
3429
3430 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3431 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3432 possible with normal servers.
3433
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003434 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003435 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3436 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3437 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3438 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3439
3440 See also : "server"
3441
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003442
3443dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3444 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3445 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3446 yes | no | yes | yes
3447 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3448
3449 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003450 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003451 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3452 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003453 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003454 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003455
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003456enabled
3457 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3459 yes | yes | yes | yes
3460 Arguments : none
3461
3462 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3463 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3464
3465 See also : "disabled"
3466
3467
3468errorfile <code> <file>
3469 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3471 yes | yes | yes | yes
3472 Arguments :
3473 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003474 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3475 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
3477 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003478 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003479 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003480 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3481 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003482
3483 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3484 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3485 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3486
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003487 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003489 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3490 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3491 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3492 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3493
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003494 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3495 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003496 not to put any reference to local contents (e.g. images) in order to avoid
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003497 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3498 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3499 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3500
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003501 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3502 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3503 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003504 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003505 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3506
3507 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3508
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003509 Example :
3510 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003511 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003512 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3513 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3514
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003515
3516errorloc <code> <url>
3517errorloc302 <code> <url>
3518 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3519 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3520 yes | yes | yes | yes
3521 Arguments :
3522 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003523 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3524 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003525
3526 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3527 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3528 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3529 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003530 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003531
3532 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3533 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3534 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3535
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003536 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3537
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003538 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3539 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3540 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3541 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003542 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003543 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3544 request.
3545
3546 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3547
3548
3549errorloc303 <code> <url>
3550 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3552 yes | yes | yes | yes
3553 Arguments :
3554 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Olivier Houchard51a76d82017-10-02 16:12:07 +02003555 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 425, 429, 500, 502,
3556 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003557
3558 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3559 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3560 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3561 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003562 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003563
3564 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3565 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3566 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3567
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003568 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3569
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003570 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3571 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3572 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3573 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003574 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003575
3576 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3577
3578
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003579email-alert from <emailaddr>
3580 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003581 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3583 yes | yes | yes | yes
3584
3585 Arguments :
3586
3587 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3588
3589 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3590 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3591
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003592 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003593 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3594 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003595
3596
3597email-alert level <level>
3598 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3599 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3600 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3601 yes | yes | yes | yes
3602
3603 Arguments :
3604
3605 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3606 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3607 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3608
3609 By default level is alert
3610
3611 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3612 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3613 for the proxy.
3614
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003615 Alerts are sent when :
3616
3617 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3618 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3619 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3620 is notice or lower
3621 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3622 and a health check status update occurs
3623
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003624 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3625 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003626 section 3.6 about mailers.
3627
3628
3629email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3630 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3631 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3632 yes | yes | yes | yes
3633
3634 Arguments :
3635
3636 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3637
3638 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3639 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3640
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003641 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3642 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003643
3644
3645email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3646 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3647 mailers.
3648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3649 yes | yes | yes | yes
3650
3651 Arguments :
3652
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003653 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003654
3655 By default the systems hostname is used.
3656
3657 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3658 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3659 for the proxy.
3660
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003661 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3662 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003663
3664
3665email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003666 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003667 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3668 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3669 yes | yes | yes | yes
3670
3671 Arguments :
3672
3673 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3674
3675 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3676 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3677
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003678 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003679 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3680
3681
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003682force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3683 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3684 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003685 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003686
3687 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3688 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3689 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3690 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3691 marked down for maintenance operations.
3692
3693 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3694 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3695 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3696 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3697 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3698 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3699 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3700 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3701 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3702
3703 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3704 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3705 is used.
3706
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003707 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003708 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003709
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003710
3711filter <name> [param*]
3712 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3714 no | yes | yes | yes
3715 Arguments :
3716 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3717 referenced in section 9.
3718
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003719 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003720 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003721 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3722 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003723
3724 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3725 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3726
3727 Example:
3728 listen
3729 bind *:80
3730
3731 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3732 filter compression
3733 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3734
3735 compression algo gzip
3736 compression offload
3737
3738 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3739
3740 See also : section 9.
3741
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003742
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003743fullconn <conns>
3744 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3746 yes | no | yes | yes
3747 Arguments :
3748 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3749 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3750
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003751 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003752 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003753 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003754 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3755 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3756 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3757 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3758 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003759 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003760
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003761 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3762 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003763 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3764 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3765 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003766
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003767 Example :
3768 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3769 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3770 # connections.
3771 backend dynamic
3772 fullconn 10000
3773 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3774 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3775
3776 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3777
3778
3779grace <time>
3780 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003782 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003783 Arguments :
3784 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3785 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3786 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3787
3788 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3789 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003790 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003791 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3792
3793 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3794 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3795 simplify it.
3796
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003797
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003798hash-balance-factor <factor>
3799 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3801 yes | no | no | yes
3802 Arguments :
3803 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3804 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3805 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3806
3807 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3808 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3809 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3810 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3811 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3812 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3813 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3814
3815 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3816 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3817 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3818 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3819 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3820
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003821 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
3822 consistent hashing mechanism.
3823
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003824 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3825
3826
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003827hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003828 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3829 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3830 yes | no | yes | yes
3831 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003832 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3833 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003834
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003835 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3836 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3837 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3838 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3839 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3840 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3841 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3842 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3843 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3844 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003845
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003846 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3847 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3848 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3849 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3850 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3851 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3852 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3853 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3854 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3855 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3856 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3857 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3858 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003859 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3860 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003861
3862 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3863
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003864 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003865 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3866 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3867 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003868 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3869 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3870 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003871
3872 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3873 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003874 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3875 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3876 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3877 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3878
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003879 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3880 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3881 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3882 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3883 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3884 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3885 parameter.
3886
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003887 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3888 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3889 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3890 used on strings.
3891
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003892 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3893
3894 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3895 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3896 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3897 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3898 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3899 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3900 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3901 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3902 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3903 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3904 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3905 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003906
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003907 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3908 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3909 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003910
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003911 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003912
3913
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003914http-check disable-on-404
3915 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003917 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003918 Arguments : none
3919
3920 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3921 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3922 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3923 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3924 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3925 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3926 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3927 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003928 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3929 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3930 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3931
3932 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3933
3934
3935http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003936 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003938 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003939 Arguments :
3940 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3941 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003942 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003943 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3944 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3945 details on the supported keywords.
3946
3947 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3948 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3949 with the usual backslash ('\').
3950
3951 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3952 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3953 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3954 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3955 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3956
3957 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003958 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003959 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3960 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3961 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3962
3963 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003964 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003965 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3966 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3967 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3968 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3969
3970 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003971 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003972 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3973 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3974 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3975 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3976 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003977 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003978 trace).
3979
3980 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003981 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003982 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3983 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3984 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3985 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3986 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003987 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003988
3989 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3990 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3991 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3992 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3993 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3994 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3995 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3996 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3997
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003998 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3999 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
4000 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
4001
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004002 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4003 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4004
4005 Examples :
4006 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004007 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004008
4009 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004010 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004011
4012 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004013 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004014
4015 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004016 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004017
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004018 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004019
4020
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004021http-check send-state
4022 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4024 yes | no | yes | yes
4025 Arguments : none
4026
4027 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4028 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4029 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4030 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4031 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4032
4033 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4034 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4035 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4036 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4037 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004038 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4039 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4040 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4041
4042 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4043 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4044 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4045
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004046 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4047 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4048 checked in multiple backends.
4049
4050 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4051 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4052
4053 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4054 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4055 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4056 one fails.
4057
4058 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4059 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4060 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4061
4062 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4063 server's queue.
4064
4065 Example of a header received by the application server :
4066 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4067 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4068
4069 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
4070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004071
4072http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004073 Access control for Layer 7 requests
4074
4075 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4076 no | yes | yes | yes
4077
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004078 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4079 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4080 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4081 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4082 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004083
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004084 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4085 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004086
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004087 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004088
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004089 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4090 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
4091 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4092 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
Willy Tarreau53275e82017-11-24 07:52:01 +01004093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004094 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4095 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4096 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4097 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01004098
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004099 Example:
4100 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4101 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4102 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004104 http-request allow if nagios
4105 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4106 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4107 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01004108
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004109 Example:
4110 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4111 acl add path /addacl
4112 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004113
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004114 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004116 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4117 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004119 Example:
4120 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4121 acl setmap path /setmap
4122 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004124 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004126 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4127 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004129 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4130 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004132http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004133
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004134 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4135 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4136 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4137 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4138 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
4139 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4140 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4141 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004142
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004143http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004145 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
4146 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
4147 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
4148 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
4149 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
4150 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
4151 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
4152 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004154http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004156 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
4157 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004158
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004159
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004160http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004161
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004162 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
4163 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
4164 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
4165 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
4166 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004168 Example:
4169 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
4170 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004171
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004172http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004174 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004175
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004176http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
4177 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004178
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004179 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
4180 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
4181 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
4182 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
4183 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
4184 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
4185 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
4186 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
4187 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004189 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
4190 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
4191 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
4192 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword. If the slot
4193 <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration to prevent
4194 unexpected behavior at run time.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004195
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004196http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004197
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004198 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4199 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4200 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4201 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4202 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4203 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01004204
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004205http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004206
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004207 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004208
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004209http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004210
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004211 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4212 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4213 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4214 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4215 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4216 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004217
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004218http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004219
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004220 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request
4221 and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code specified as an
4222 argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status codes is limited to
4223 those that can be overridden by the "errorfile" directive.
4224 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04004225
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004226http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4227
4228 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
4229 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
4230 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
4231 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01004232 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
4233 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01004234
4235 See RFC 8297 for more information.
4236
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004237http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004238
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004239 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
4240 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
4241 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
4242 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
4243 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004244
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004245http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004247 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
4248 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
4249 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
4250 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004251
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004252http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4253 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02004254
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004255 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field
4256 <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the
4257 <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and
4258 work like in <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header". The match is
4259 only case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4260 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they may
4261 contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas in
4262 their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02004263
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004264 Example:
4265 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004267 # applied to:
4268 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004269
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004270 # outputs:
4271 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004272
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004273 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004275http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
4276 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004278 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4279 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
4280 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
4281 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02004282
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004283 Example:
4284 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004285
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004286 # applied to:
4287 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004288
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004289 # outputs:
4290 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004292http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4293http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004294
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004295 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4296 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4297 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004299http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004301 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4302 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4303 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004304
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004305http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004306
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004307 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4308 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
4309 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
4310 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
4311 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004313 Arguments:
4314 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4315 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004317 Example:
4318 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4319 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004321 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
4322 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004323
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004324http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004326 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4327 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
4328 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004329
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004330 Arguments:
4331 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4332 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004333
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004334 Example:
4335 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4336 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004338 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4339 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4340 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004341
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004342http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004343
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004344 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
4345 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4346 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4347 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
4348 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004350 Example:
4351 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4352 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
4353 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
4354 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4355 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4356 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4357 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4358 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4359 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004360
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004361http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004363 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4364 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4365 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4366 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
4367 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004369http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004372 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4373 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4374 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4375 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4376 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4377 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4378 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4379 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4380 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004382http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004384 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4385 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4386 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4387 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
4388 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
4389 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
4390 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004392http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004393
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004394 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
4395 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
4396 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004397
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004398http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004399
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004400 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
4401 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
4402 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
4403 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
4404 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
4405 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4406 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4407 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004408
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004409http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004410
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004411 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
4412 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
4413 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
4414 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
4415 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
4416 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004418 Example :
4419 # prepend the host name before the path
4420 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004421
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004422http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02004423
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004424 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
4425 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
4426 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4427 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
4428 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004429
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004430http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004432 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
4433 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
4434 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
4435 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
4436 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
4437 values have higher priority.
4438 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
4439 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
4440 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
4441 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
4442 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004443
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004444http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004445
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004446 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
4447 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
4448 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
4449 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
4450 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
4451 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
4452 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004454 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004455
4456 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004457 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
4458 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004459
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004460http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4461 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4462 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
4463 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
4464 privacy.
4465
4466 Arguments :
4467 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4468 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004469
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004470 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004471 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4472 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4473
4474 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4475 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
4476
4477http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4478
4479 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4480 expression.
4481
4482 Arguments:
4483 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
4484 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004485
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004486 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004487 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4488 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4489
4490 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
4491 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
4492 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4493
4494http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4495
4496 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4497 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
4498 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
4499 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
4500 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
4501 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
4502 information from the request.
4503
4504 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4505
4506http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4507
4508 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
4509 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
4510 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
4511 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
4512 path and the query string.
4513 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
4514
4515http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4516
4517 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4518 inline.
4519
4520 Arguments:
4521 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4522 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4523 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4524 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4525 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4526 (request and response)
4527 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4528 processing
4529 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4530 processing
4531 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4532 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
4533 and '_'.
4534
4535 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4536 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004537
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004538 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004539 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004540
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004541http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
4542 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004544 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4545 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4546 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4547 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4548 agent name must be used.
4549
4550 Arguments:
4551 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
4552
4553 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4554 configuration.
4555
4556http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4557
4558 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4559 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4560 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4561 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4562 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4563 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4564 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4565 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4566 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4567 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4568 action.
4569 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4570 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4571 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4572 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4573 you fully understand how it works.
4574
4575http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4576
4577 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
4578 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
4579 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
4580 is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status code
4581 specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the client
4582 does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT".
4583 The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when
4584 they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
4585 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load
4586 on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
4587 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the front
4588 firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections.
4589 See also the "silent-drop" action.
4590
4591http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4592http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4593http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4594
4595 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
4596 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
4597 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
4598 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
4599 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
4600 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4601 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
4602 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
4603 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
4604 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
4605 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
4606 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4607
4608 Arguments :
4609 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
4610 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
4611 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
4612 select which table entry to update the counters.
4613
4614 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
4615 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
4616 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
4617 that table until the session ends.
4618
4619 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
4620 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
4621 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
4622 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
4623 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
4624 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
4625 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
4626 useful information.
4627
4628 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
4629 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
4630 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
4631 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
4632 checks that make use of it.
4633
4634http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4635
4636 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004637
4638 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004639 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004641http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02004643 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
4644 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
4645 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004646
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004647
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004648http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004649 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4650
4651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4652 no | yes | yes | yes
4653
4654 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4655 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4656 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4657 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4658 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4659 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4660
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004661 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4662 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004663
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004664 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004665
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004666 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
4667 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4668 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further
4669 ACL rules.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004670
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004671 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4672 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4673 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4674 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004675
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004676 Example:
4677 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004678
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004679 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004680
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004681 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4682 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004683
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004684 Example:
4685 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004686
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004687 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004688
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004689 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4690 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004691
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004692 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4693 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004694
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004695http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004696
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004697 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4698 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4699 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4700 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
4701 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4702 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4703 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4704 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004705
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004706http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004707
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004708 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4709 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4710 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4711 example, or to pass some internal information.
4712 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4713 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4714 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004715
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004716http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004717
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004718 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4719 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004720
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02004721http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004722
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004723 See section 10.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004725http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004726
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004727 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
4728 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4729 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4730 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4731 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4732 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
4733 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004734
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004735 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
4736 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4737 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
4738 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4739 keyword.
4740 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the configuration
4741 to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004742
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004743http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004744
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004745 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
4746 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
4747 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4748 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4749 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
4750 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004751
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004752http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004753
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004754 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004755
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004756http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004757
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004758 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4759 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4760 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
4761 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4762 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4763 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004764
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004765http-response deny [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004766
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004767 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response
4768 and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004769
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004770http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004771
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004772 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4773 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4774 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
4775 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
4776 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
4777 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004778
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004779http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4780 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004781
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004782 This matches the regular expression in all occurrences of header field <name>
4783 according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with the <replace-fmt> argument.
4784 Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt and work like in <fmt> arguments
4785 in "add-header". The match is only case-sensitive. It is important to
4786 understand that this action only considers whole header lines, regardless of
4787 the number of values they may contain. This usage is suited to headers
4788 naturally containing commas in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and
4789 so on.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01004790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004791 Example:
4792 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004793
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004794 # applied to:
4795 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004796
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004797 # outputs:
4798 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004799
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004800 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004801
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004802http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4803 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004804
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004805 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
4806 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the entire
4807 header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry more than
4808 one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004809
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004810 Example:
4811 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004812
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004813 # applied to:
4814 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004815
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004816 # outputs:
4817 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004818
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004819http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4820http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004821
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004822 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
4823 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
4824 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004825
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004826http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004827
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004828 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated by
4829 <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If an error
4830 occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01004831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004832http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004833
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004834 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
4835 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
4836 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
4837 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
4838 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004839
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004840 Arguments:
4841 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004842
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004843 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
4844 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02004845
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004846http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004848 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4849 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4850 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004851
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004852http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4853
4854 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
4855 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
4856 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
4857 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
4858 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
4859
4860http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
4861
4862 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
4863 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
4864 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
4865 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
4866 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
4867 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
4868 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
4869 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
4870 be triggered by an HTTP response.
4871
4872http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4873
4874 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
4875 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
4876 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
4877 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
4878 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
4879 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
4880 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
4881
4882http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4883
4884 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4885 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4886 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4887 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4888 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
4889 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
4890 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
4891 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4892
4893http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4894 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4895
4896 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4897 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4898 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4899 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004900
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004901 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004902 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4903 http-response set-status 431
4904 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4905 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004906
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004907http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004908
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004909 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
4910 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4911 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4912 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
4913 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
4914 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
4915 based on some information from the request.
4916
4917 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4918
4919http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4920
4921 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4922 inline.
4923
4924 Arguments:
4925 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4926 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4927 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4928 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4929 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4930 (request and response)
4931 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4932 processing
4933 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4934 processing
4935 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4936 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4937 and '_'.
4938
4939 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4940 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004941
4942 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004943 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004945http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004946
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004947 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
4948 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
4949 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
4950 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
4951 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
4952 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
4953 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
4954 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
4955 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
4956 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
4957 action.
4958 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
4959 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
4960 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
4961 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
4962 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004964http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4965http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4966http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02004968 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
4969 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4970 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
4971 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
4972 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
4973 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4974
4975http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4976
4977 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
4978 about <var-name>.
4979
4980 Example:
4981 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4982
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004983
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004984http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4985 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4986
4987 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4988 yes | no | yes | yes
4989
4990 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004991 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
4992 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
4993 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004994
4995 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4996
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01004997 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
4998 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
4999 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
5000 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
5001 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
5002 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
5003 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
5004 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
5005 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
5006 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005007
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01005008 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
5009 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
5010 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
5011 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
5012 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
5013 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
5014 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
5015 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005016
5017 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
5018 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
5019 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
5020 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
5021 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
5022 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
5023 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
5024 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
5025 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
5026 downsides of rare connection failures.
5027
5028 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
5029 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
5030 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
5031 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
5032 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
5033 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005034 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005035 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
5036 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
5037 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
5038 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
5039 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
5040
5041 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005042 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
5043 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
5044 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005045
5046 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005047 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005048
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02005049 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
5050 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02005051
5052 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
5053 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
5054 may not last after all sessions are closed.
5055
5056 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
5057 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
5058 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
5059
5060 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
5061
5062
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005063http-send-name-header [<header>]
5064 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
5065
5066 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5067 yes | no | yes | yes
5068
5069 Arguments :
5070
5071 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
5072
5073 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005074 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05005075 is added with the header string proved.
5076
5077 See also : "server"
5078
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005079id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02005080 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 no | yes | yes | yes
5083 Arguments : none
5084
5085 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
5086 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
5087 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01005088
5089
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005090ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5091 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
5092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005093 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005094
5095 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
5096 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
5097 and running).
5098
5099 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5100 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
5101 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005102 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005103 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
5104
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005105 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5106 "unless" condition is met.
5107
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005108 Example:
5109 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
5110 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
5111 ignore-persist if url_static
5112
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005113 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
5114
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005115load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
5116 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
5117 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5118 yes | no | yes | yes
5119
5120 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
5121 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
5122 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005123 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005124 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
5125 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
5126 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
5127 over the stats socket and redirect output.
5128
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005129 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005130 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02005131 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005132
5133 Arguments:
5134 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
5135 named "server-state-file".
5136
5137 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
5138 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
5139 name is used as a file name.
5140
5141 none don't load any stat for this backend
5142
5143 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005144 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
5145 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
5146 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005147 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01005148 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005149
5150 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
5151 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
5152
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005153 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005154
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005155 global
5156 stats socket /tmp/socket
5157 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005158
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005159 defaults
5160 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005161
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005162 backend bk
5163 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5164 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005165
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005166
5167 Then one can run :
5168
5169 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
5170
5171 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
5172
5173 1
5174 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5175 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5176 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5177
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005178 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005179
5180 global
5181 stats socket /tmp/socket
5182 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
5183
5184 defaults
5185 load-server-state-from-file local
5186
5187 backend bk
5188 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
5189 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
5190
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005191
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02005192 Then one can run :
5193
5194 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
5195
5196 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
5197
5198 1
5199 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
5200 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5201 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
5202
5203 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
5204 "show servers state"
5205
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005206
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005207log global
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005208log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005209no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005210 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
5211 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5212 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005213
5214 Prefix :
5215 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
5216 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
5217 prefix does not allow arguments.
5218
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005219 Arguments :
5220 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
5221 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
5222 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
5223 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
5224 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
5225 parameter.
5226
5227 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
5228 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
5229
5230 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
5231 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5232 standard syslog port).
5233
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01005234 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
5235 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
5236 standard syslog port).
5237
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005238 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
5239 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
5240 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005241 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005242
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005243 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
5244 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
5245 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
5246 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
5247 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
5248 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
5249 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
5250 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
5251 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
5252 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
5253 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
5254 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
5255 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
5256 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
5257 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
5258 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005259 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
5260 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01005261
5262 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
5263 and "fd@2", see above.
5264
5265 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5266 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005267
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005268 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
5269 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
5270 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
5271 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
5272 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
5273 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
5274 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
5275 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
5276 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
5277 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005278 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02005279
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01005280 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
5281 one of the following :
5282
5283 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
5284 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
5285
5286 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
5287 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
5288
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005289 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
5290 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
5291 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
5292 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
5293 systemd logger consumes.
5294
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005295 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
5296 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
5297 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
5298 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
5299
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005300 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
5301
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01005302 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
5303 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
5304 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
5305
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005306 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
5307 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
5308 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
5309 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005310
5311 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
5312 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
5313 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005314 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
5315 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
5316 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
5317 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
5318 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005319
5320 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5321
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02005322 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
5323 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
5324 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005325
5326 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
5327 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
5328 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
5329 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
5330
5331 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
5332 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005333
5334 Example :
5335 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01005336 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
5337 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
5338 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02005339 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
5340 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005341 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005342
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005343
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005344log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005345 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
5346 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5347 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005348
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01005349 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
5350 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
5351 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
5352 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5353 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01005354
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005355 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
5356 "option httplog" directives.
5357
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02005358log-format-sd <string>
5359 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
5360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | yes | yes | no
5362
5363 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
5364 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
5365 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
5366 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
5367 which covers the log format string in depth.
5368
5369 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
5370 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
5371
5372 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
5373 log format to "rfc5424".
5374
5375 Example :
5376 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
5377
5378
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01005379log-tag <string>
5380 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
5381 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5382 yes | yes | yes | yes
5383
5384 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
5385 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
5386 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
5387 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
5388 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
5389 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
5390 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
5391 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
5392 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005393
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005394max-keep-alive-queue <value>
5395 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
5396 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5397 yes | no | yes | yes
5398
5399 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
5400 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
5401 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
5402 servers.
5403
5404 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
5405 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
5406 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
5407 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
5408 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005409 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005410 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
5411 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
5412 picking a different server.
5413
5414 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
5415 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
5416 even if they have to be queued.
5417
5418 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
5419 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
5420
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01005421max-session-srv-conns <nb>
5422 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
5423 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
5424 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02005425
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005426maxconn <conns>
5427 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
5428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5429 yes | yes | yes | no
5430 Arguments :
5431 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
5432 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
5433 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
5434 closes.
5435
5436 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
5437 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
5438 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
5439 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01005440 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
5441 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
5442 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
5443 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005444
5445 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
5446 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
5447 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
5448
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02005449 By default, this value is set to 2000.
5450
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005451 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
5452
5453
5454mode { tcp|http|health }
5455 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
5456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5457 yes | yes | yes | yes
5458 Arguments :
5459 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
5460 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
5461 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
5462 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
5463
5464 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
5465 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
5466 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
5467 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
5468 brings HAProxy most of its value.
5469
5470 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005471 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
5472 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
5473 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
5474 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
5475 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
5476 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
5477 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005478
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005479 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
5480 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
5481 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005482
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005483 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005484 defaults http_instances
5485 mode http
5486
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005487 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005488
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005489
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005490monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005491 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5493 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005494 Arguments :
5495 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
5496 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005497 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005498 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
5499 backend and its backup.
5500
5501 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
5502 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
5503 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
5504 servers in a list of backends.
5505
5506 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
5507 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
5508 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
5509 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
5510 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
5511 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
5512 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005513 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5514 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005515
5516 Example:
5517 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005518 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005519 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5520 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5521 monitor-uri /site_alive
5522 monitor fail if site_dead
5523
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005524 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005525
5526
5527monitor-net <source>
5528 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5530 yes | yes | yes | no
5531 Arguments :
5532 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5533 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5534 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5535 followed by a mask.
5536
5537 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5538 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005539 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005540 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5541
5542 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5543 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5544 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5545 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005546 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5547 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5548 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005549
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005550 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5551 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5552 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5553 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5554 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5555 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005556
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005557 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5558 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005559
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005560 Example :
5561 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5562 frontend www
5563 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5564
5565 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5566
5567
5568monitor-uri <uri>
5569 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5571 yes | yes | yes | no
5572 Arguments :
5573 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5574 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5575
5576 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5577 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5578 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5579 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5580 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5581 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5582 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5583 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5584
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01005585 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
5586 and even before any "http-request" or "block" rulesets. The only rulesets
5587 applied before are the tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it
5588 is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an
5589 upper component, nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of
5590 conditions using "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted
5591 to whatever check can be imagined (most often the number of available servers
5592 in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005593
5594 Example :
5595 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5596 frontend www
5597 mode http
5598 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5599
5600 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5601
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005602
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005603option abortonclose
5604no option abortonclose
5605 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5607 yes | no | yes | yes
5608 Arguments : none
5609
5610 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5611 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5612 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5613 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005614 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005615 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5616 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5617 encountered while delivering the response.
5618
5619 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5620 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5621 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5622 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5623 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5624 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005625 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005626 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005627 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005628 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5629 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5630 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5631
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005632 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
5633 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005634 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5635 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5636 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5637 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5638 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5639 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005640 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005641
5642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5644
5645 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5646
5647
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005648option accept-invalid-http-request
5649no option accept-invalid-http-request
5650 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5652 yes | yes | yes | no
5653 Arguments : none
5654
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005655 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005656 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005657 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005658 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5659 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5660 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5661 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5662 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005663 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5664 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5665 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5666 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005667 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005668 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005669 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5670 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5671 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005672
5673 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5674 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5675 been confirmed.
5676
5677 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5678 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005679 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5680 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005681 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5682
5683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5685
5686 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5687 stats socket.
5688
5689
5690option accept-invalid-http-response
5691no option accept-invalid-http-response
5692 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5694 yes | no | yes | yes
5695 Arguments : none
5696
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005697 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005698 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005699 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005700 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5701 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5702 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5703 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5704 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005705 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5706 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5707 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005708
5709 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5710 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5711 been confirmed.
5712
5713 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5714 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5715 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5716 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5717
5718 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5719 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5720
5721 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5722 stats socket.
5723
5724
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005725option allbackups
5726no option allbackups
5727 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | no | yes | yes
5730 Arguments : none
5731
5732 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5733 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5734 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5735 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5736 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5737 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5738 order between the backup servers anymore.
5739
5740 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5741 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5742
5743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5745
5746
5747option checkcache
5748no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005749 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005750 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5751 yes | no | yes | yes
5752 Arguments : none
5753
5754 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5755 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005756 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005757 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5758 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005759 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005760
5761 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005762 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005763 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005764 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5765 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005766 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005767 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01005768 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
5769 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005770 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01005771 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
5772 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005773 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005774 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5775 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5776 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5777 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5778 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5779 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5780 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5781 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5782 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5783
5784 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005785 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005786 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005787 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005788 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5789
5790 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5791 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005792 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005793 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005794
5795 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5796 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5797
5798
5799option clitcpka
5800no option clitcpka
5801 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5802 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5803 yes | yes | yes | no
5804 Arguments : none
5805
5806 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5807 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005808 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005809 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5810
5811 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5812 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5813 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5814 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5815
5816 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5817 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5818 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5819 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5820 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5821
5822 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5823
5824 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5825 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5826 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5827
5828 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5829 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5830
5831 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5832
5833
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005834option contstats
5835 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5837 yes | yes | yes | no
5838 Arguments : none
5839
5840 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5841 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5842 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5843 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005844 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5845 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5846 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5847 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5848 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005849
5850
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005851option dontlog-normal
5852no option dontlog-normal
5853 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5855 yes | yes | yes | no
5856 Arguments : none
5857
5858 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5859 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5860 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5861 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5862 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5863 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5864 logged.
5865
5866 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5867 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5868 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005870 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005871 logging.
5872
5873
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005874option dontlognull
5875no option dontlognull
5876 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 yes | yes | yes | no
5879 Arguments : none
5880
5881 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5882 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5883 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5884 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5885 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5886 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005887 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5888 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5889 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005890
5891 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005892 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005893 would not be logged.
5894
5895 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5896 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5897
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005898 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5899 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005900
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005901
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005902option forceclose (deprecated)
5903no option forceclose (deprecated)
5904 This is an alias for "option httpclose". Thus this option is deprecated.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005905
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005906 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005907
5908
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005909option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005910 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5912 yes | yes | yes | yes
5913 Arguments :
5914 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5915 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005916 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005917 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005918
5919 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5920 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5921 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5922 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5923 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5924 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5925 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005926 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5927 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5928 possible that the client has already brought one.
5929
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005930 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005931 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005932 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005933 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005934 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005935 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005936
5937 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5938 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5939 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5940 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5941 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5942 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5943 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5944
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005945 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5946 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5947 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5948 are under the control of the end-user.
5949
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005950 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005951 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5952 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005953 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5954 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5955 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005956
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005957 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005958 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5959 frontend www
5960 mode http
5961 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5962
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005963 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5964 backend www
5965 mode http
5966 option forwardfor header X-Client
5967
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005968 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02005969 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005970
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005971
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005972option http-buffer-request
5973no option http-buffer-request
5974 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5976 yes | yes | yes | yes
5977 Arguments : none
5978
5979 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5980 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5981 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5982 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5983 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5984 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5985 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5986 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005987 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005988 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5989 default.
5990
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005991 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005992
5993
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005994option http-ignore-probes
5995no option http-ignore-probes
5996 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5998 yes | yes | yes | no
5999 Arguments : none
6000
6001 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
6002 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
6003 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
6004 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
6005 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
6006 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
6007 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
6008 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
6009 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006010 was received over a connection before it was closed;
6011 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02006012 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
6013
6014 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
6015 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
6016 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
6017 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
6018 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
6019 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
6020 are often the only way to detect them.
6021
6022 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6023 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6024
6025 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
6026
6027
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006028option http-keep-alive
6029no option http-keep-alive
6030 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
6031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6032 yes | yes | yes | yes
6033 Arguments : none
6034
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006035 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6036 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006037 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6038 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
6039 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6040 This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when
6041 another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006042
6043 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
6044 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006045 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
6046 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
6047 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
6048 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
6049 situations where this option may be useful :
6050
6051 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006052 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006053
6054 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
6055 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
6056
6057 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
6058 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
6059 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
6060 request.
6061
6062 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
6063 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006064 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
6065 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
6066 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006067
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006068 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6069 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6070 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6071 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
6072 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6073 not set.
6074
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006075 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006076 http-server-close" or "option http-tunnel". When backend and frontend options
6077 differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006078
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006079 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006080 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006081 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006082
6083
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006084option http-no-delay
6085no option http-no-delay
6086 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
6087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6088 yes | yes | yes | yes
6089 Arguments : none
6090
6091 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
6092 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
6093 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
6094 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
6095 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
6096 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
6097 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
6098 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
6099 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
6100 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
6101 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
6102 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
6103 affected.
6104
6105 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
6106 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
6107 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
6108 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
6109 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
6110 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
6111 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
6112 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
6113 latency environments.
6114
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02006115 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6116
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02006117
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006118option http-pretend-keepalive
6119no option http-pretend-keepalive
6120 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
6121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006122 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006123 Arguments : none
6124
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006125 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006126 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
6127 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
6128 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
6129 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
6130 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
6131 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
6132 consider the response complete.
6133
6134 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
6135 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
6136 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
6137 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006138 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006139 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
6140
6141 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
6142 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
6143 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
6144 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
6145 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
6146 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
6147 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
6148
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02006149 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
6150 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
6151 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6152 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
6153 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
6154 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006155
6156 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6157 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6158
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006159 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01006160 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02006161
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006162
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006163option http-server-close
6164no option http-server-close
6165 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
6166 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6167 yes | yes | yes | yes
6168 Arguments : none
6169
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006170 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6171 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6172 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6173 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006174 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
6175 Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the
6176 server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and
6177 pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client
6178 side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save
6179 server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
6180 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
6181 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
6182 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
6183 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
6184 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006185
6186 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
6187 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
6188 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
6189 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01006190 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
6191 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006192
6193 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6194 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006195 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option http-tunnel"
6196 or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how
6197 this option combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006198
6199 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6200 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6201
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006202 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
6203 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01006204
6205
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006206option http-tunnel
6207no option http-tunnel
6208 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
6209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006210 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006211 Arguments : none
6212
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006213 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6214 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6215 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6216 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006217 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006218
6219 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006220 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006221 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
6222 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
6223 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
6224 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
6225 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
6226 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
6227 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006228
Christopher Faulet4212a302018-09-21 10:42:19 +02006229 This option may be set on frontend and listen sections. Using it on a backend
6230 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during the startup. It
6231 is a frontend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
6232 backend.
6233
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006234 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6235 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6236
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006237 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6238 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01006239
6240
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006241option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006242no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006243 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
6244 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6245 yes | yes | yes | no
6246 Arguments : none
6247
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00006248 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006249 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
6250 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
6251 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
6252 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
6253 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
6254 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
6255
6256 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
6257 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006258 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
6259 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
6260 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006261
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01006262 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
6263 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
6264 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
6265 front of an existing proxy.
6266
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006267 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
6268
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006269 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01006270
6271
Willy Tarreau68ad3a42018-10-22 11:49:15 +02006272option http-use-htx
6273no option http-use-htx
6274 Switch to the new HTX internal representation for HTTP protocol elements
6275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6276 yes | yes | yes | yes
6277 Arguments : none
6278
6279 By default, the HTTP protocol is processed as-is. Inserting, deleting, or
6280 modifying a header field requires to rewrite the affected part in the buffer
6281 and to move the buffer's tail accordingly. Since this principle has deep
6282 roots in haproxy, the HTTP/2 protocol is converted to HTTP/1.1 before being
6283 processed this way. It also results in the inability to establish HTTP/2
6284 connections to servers because of the loss of HTTP/2 semantics in the HTTP/1
6285 representation.
6286
6287 HTX is the name of a totally new native internal representation for the HTTP
6288 protocol, that is agnostic to the version and aims at preserving semantics
6289 all along the chain. It relies on a fast parsing, tokenizing and indexing of
6290 the protocol elements so that no more memory moves are necessary and that
6291 most elements are directly accessed. This mechanism is still limited to the
6292 most basic operations (no compression, filters, Lua, applets, cache, etc).
6293 But it supports using either HTTP/1 or HTTP/2 on any side regardless of the
6294 other side's version.
6295
6296 This option indicates that HTX needs to be used. It will cause errors to be
6297 emitted if incompatible features are used, but will allow H2 to be selected
6298 as a server protocol. It is recommended to use this option on new reasonably
6299 simple configurations, but since the feature still has incomplete functional
6300 coverage, it is not enabled by default.
6301
6302 See also : "mode http"
6303
6304
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006305option httpchk
6306option httpchk <uri>
6307option httpchk <method> <uri>
6308option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
6309 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
6310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6311 yes | no | yes | yes
6312 Arguments :
6313 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
6314 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
6315 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
6316 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
6317 ones.
6318
6319 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
6320 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6321 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6322
6323 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
6324 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
6325 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
6326 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
6327 after "\r\n" following the version string.
6328
6329 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
6330 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
6331 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
6332 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
6333 the lack of any response.
6334
6335 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
6336
6337 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
6338 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
6339 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
6340
6341 Examples :
6342 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
6343 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
6344 backend https_relay
6345 mode tcp
6346 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
6347 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
6348
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09006349 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
6350 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
6351 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01006352
6353
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006354option httpclose
6355no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006356 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6358 yes | yes | yes | yes
6359 Arguments : none
6360
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006361 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
6362 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
6363 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
6364 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006365 as "option http-server-close", "option httpclose" or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01006366
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006367 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
6368 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
6369 alos check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
6370 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
6371 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006372
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006373 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
6374 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
6375 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006376
6377 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
6378 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01006379 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006380 "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please check section 4
6381 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
6382 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006383
6384 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6385 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6386
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006387 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006388
6389
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006390option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006391 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
6392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01006393 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006394 Arguments :
6395 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
6396 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
6397 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006398 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006399 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006400
6401 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6402 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6403 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
6404 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
6405 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
6406 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
6407 ports.
6408
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01006409 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
6410 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02006411
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006412 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6413
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006414 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006415
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006416
6417option http_proxy
6418no option http_proxy
6419 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
6420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6421 yes | yes | yes | yes
6422 Arguments : none
6423
6424 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
6425 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
6426 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
6427 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
6428 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
6429
6430 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
6431 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01006432 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
6433 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006434
6435 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6436 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6437
6438 Example :
6439 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
6440 backend direct_forward
6441 option httpclose
6442 option http_proxy
6443
6444 See also : "option httpclose"
6445
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006446
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006447option independent-streams
6448no option independent-streams
6449 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6451 yes | yes | yes | yes
6452 Arguments : none
6453
6454 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
6455 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
6456 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
6457 receive data or not.
6458
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006459 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006460 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
6461 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
6462 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
6463 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
6464 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
6465 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
6466 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
6467 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
6468 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
6469 socket buffers.
6470
6471 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
6472 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
6473 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
6474 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
6475 slow lines, so use it with caution.
6476
Lukas Tribus745f15e2018-11-08 12:41:42 +01006477 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independant-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006478 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
6479 deprecated.
6480
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02006481 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02006482
6483
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02006484option ldap-check
6485 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
6486 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6487 yes | no | yes | yes
6488 Arguments : none
6489
6490 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
6491 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
6492 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
6493 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
6494
6495 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
6496 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
6497
6498 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
6499 configure it.
6500
6501 Example :
6502 option ldap-check
6503
6504 See also : "option httpchk"
6505
6506
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006507option external-check
6508 Use external processes for server health checks
6509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6510 yes | no | yes | yes
6511
6512 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6513 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6514 command".
6515
6516 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6517
6518 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6519
6520
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006521option log-health-checks
6522no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006523 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6525 yes | no | yes | yes
6526 Arguments : none
6527
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006528 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6529 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6530 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006531
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006532 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6533 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6534 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6535 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6536 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6537
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006538 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006539 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006540
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006541 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6542 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6543 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006544
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006545
6546option log-separate-errors
6547no option log-separate-errors
6548 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6550 yes | yes | yes | no
6551 Arguments : none
6552
6553 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6554 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6555 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6556 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6557 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6558 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6559 provides very important information.
6560
6561 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6562 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6563 error logs.
6564
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006565 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006566 logging.
6567
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006568
6569option logasap
6570no option logasap
6571 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6573 yes | yes | yes | no
6574 Arguments : none
6575
6576 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6577 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6578 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6579 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6580 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6581 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6582 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006583 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006584 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6585 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6586
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006587 Examples :
6588 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6589 mode http
6590 option httplog
6591 option logasap
6592 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6593
6594 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6595 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6596 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6597 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006599 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006600 logging.
6601
6602
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006603option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006604 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6606 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006607 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006608 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6609 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006610 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006611
6612 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6613 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006614 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006615 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6616 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6617 in the MySQL table, like this :
6618
6619 USE mysql;
6620 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6621 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6622
6623 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006624 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006625 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6626 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6627 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6628 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6629 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6630 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6631 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6632
6633 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6634 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006635
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006636 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006637
6638 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6639 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6640 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6641 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006642 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6643 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006644
6645 See also: "option httpchk"
6646
6647
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006648option nolinger
6649no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006650 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006651 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6652 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006653 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006654
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006655 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006656 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6657 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6658 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6659 connections.
6660
6661 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6662 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6663 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6664 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6665 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6666 this too.
6667
6668 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6669 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6670 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6671
6672 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6673 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6674 for servers.
6675
6676 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6677 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6678
6679
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006680option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6681 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6683 yes | yes | yes | yes
6684 Arguments :
6685 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6686 matching <network>
6687 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6688 header name.
6689
6690 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6691 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6692 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6693 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6694 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6695 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6696 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6697 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6698 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6699 possible that the client has already brought one.
6700
6701 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6702 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6703 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6704 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6705 header and requires different one.
6706
6707 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6708 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6709 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6710 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6711 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6712 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6713 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6714
6715 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6716 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6717 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6718 both are defined.
6719
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006720 Examples :
6721 # Original Destination address
6722 frontend www
6723 mode http
6724 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6725
6726 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6727 backend www
6728 mode http
6729 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6730
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02006731 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006732
6733
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006734option persist
6735no option persist
6736 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6737 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6738 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006739 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006740
6741 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6742 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6743 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6744 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6745 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6746 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6747 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6748 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6749 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6750 redirected to another valid server.
6751
6752 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6753 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6754
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006755 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006756
6757
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006758option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6759 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | no | yes | yes
6762 Arguments :
6763 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6764 PostgreSQL server.
6765
6766 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6767 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6768 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6769 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6770
6771 See also: "option httpchk"
6772
6773
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006774option prefer-last-server
6775no option prefer-last-server
6776 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6777 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6778 yes | no | yes | yes
6779 Arguments : none
6780
6781 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6782 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6783 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6784 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6785 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6786 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6787 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6788 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6789 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006790 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6791 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02006792 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
6793 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
6794 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006795 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6796 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6797 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006798
6799 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6800 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6801
6802 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6803
6804
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006805option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006806option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006807no option redispatch
6808 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6810 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006811 Arguments :
6812 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6813 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6814 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006815 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006816 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006817 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006818 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6819 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6820 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006822
6823 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6824 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6825 be able to access the service anymore.
6826
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01006827 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
6828 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006829
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006830 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006831 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6832 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006834 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6835 "redisp" keywords.
6836
6837 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6838 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6839
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006840 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006841
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006842
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006843option redis-check
6844 Use redis health checks for server testing
6845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6846 yes | no | yes | yes
6847 Arguments : none
6848
6849 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6850 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6851 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6852 find the "+PONG" response message.
6853
6854 Example :
6855 option redis-check
6856
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006857 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006858
6859
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006860option smtpchk
6861option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6862 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6863 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6864 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006865 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006866 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02006867 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006868 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6869
6870 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6871 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6872 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6873
6874 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6875 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6876 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6877 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6878 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6879 dead server.
6880
6881 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6882 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006883 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006884 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6885
6886 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6887 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6888 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6889 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006890 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006891
6892 Example :
6893 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6894
6895 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6896
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006898option socket-stats
6899no option socket-stats
6900
6901 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6902 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6903 yes | yes | yes | no
6904
6905 Arguments : none
6906
6907
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006908option splice-auto
6909no option splice-auto
6910 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | yes | yes | yes
6913 Arguments : none
6914
6915 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6916 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006917 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006918 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006919 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006920 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6921 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6922 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6923 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6924
6925 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6926 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6927 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6928 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6929 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6930 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6931 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6932 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6933 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6934 keyword.
6935
6936 Example :
6937 option splice-auto
6938
6939 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6940 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6941
6942 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6943 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6944
6945
6946option splice-request
6947no option splice-request
6948 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | yes | yes | yes
6951 Arguments : none
6952
6953 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006954 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006955 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6956 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6957 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6958 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6959
6960 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6961
6962 Example :
6963 option splice-request
6964
6965 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6966 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6967
6968 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6969 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6970
6971
6972option splice-response
6973no option splice-response
6974 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6976 yes | yes | yes | yes
6977 Arguments : none
6978
6979 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006980 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006981 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6982 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6983 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6984 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6985
6986 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6987
6988 Example :
6989 option splice-response
6990
6991 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6992 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6993
6994 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6995 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6996
6997
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006998option spop-check
6999 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 no | no | no | yes
7002 Arguments : none
7003
7004 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
7005 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
7006 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
7007 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
7008
7009 Example :
7010 option spop-check
7011
7012 See also : "option httpchk"
7013
7014
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007015option srvtcpka
7016no option srvtcpka
7017 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 yes | no | yes | yes
7020 Arguments : none
7021
7022 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7023 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007024 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007025 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7026
7027 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7028 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7029 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7030 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7031
7032 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7033 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7034 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7035 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7036 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7037
7038 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7039
7040 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7041 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7042 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
7043
7044 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7045 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7046
7047 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
7048
7049
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007050option ssl-hello-chk
7051 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
7052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7053 yes | no | yes | yes
7054 Arguments : none
7055
7056 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
7057 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
7058 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
7059 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
7060 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
7061 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
7062 hello message.
7063
7064 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
7065 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
7066 messages, which is appreciable.
7067
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007068 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
7069 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
7070 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007071
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02007072 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
7073
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01007074
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007075option tcp-check
7076 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
7077 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7078 yes | no | yes | yes
7079
7080 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
7081 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
7082
7083 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
7084 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
7085 attempt, which remains the default mode.
7086
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007087 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007088 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
7089 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
7090 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
7091 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
7092 only.
7093
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007094 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007095 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
7096 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
7097 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
7098 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
7099
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007100 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007101 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
7102 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007103 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007104 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
7105 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
7106 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
7107 the respective protocols.
7108 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007109 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007110
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007111 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
7112 script.
7113
7114 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
7115 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
7116 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
7117 The "comment" is of course optional.
7118
7119
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007120 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007121 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007122 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007123 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007125 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007126 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007127 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007128
7129 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
7130 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007131 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007132 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007133 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007134 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02007135 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007136 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007137 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
7138 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007139 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007140 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
7141 tcp-check expect string +OK
7142
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007143 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007144 (send many headers before analyzing)
7145 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007146 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007147 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
7148 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
7149 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
7150 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02007151 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01007152
7153
7154 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
7155
7156
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007157option tcp-smart-accept
7158no option tcp-smart-accept
7159 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
7160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7161 yes | yes | yes | no
7162 Arguments : none
7163
7164 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
7165 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
7166 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
7167 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
7168 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
7169 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
7170
7171 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
7172 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
7173 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
7174 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
7175
7176 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
7177 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
7178 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007179 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007180
7181 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
7182 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
7183 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
7184
7185 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
7186 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
7187 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
7188
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02007189 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
7190
7191
7192option tcp-smart-connect
7193no option tcp-smart-connect
7194 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
7195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7196 yes | no | yes | yes
7197 Arguments : none
7198
7199 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
7200 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
7201 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
7202 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
7203 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
7204
7205 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
7206 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
7207 complex.
7208
7209 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
7210 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
7211 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
7212
7213 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7214 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7215
7216 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
7217
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02007218
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007219option tcpka
7220 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
7221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7222 yes | yes | yes | yes
7223 Arguments : none
7224
7225 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7226 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007227 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007228 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7229
7230 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7231 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7232 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7233 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7234
7235 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7236 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7237 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7238 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7239 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7240
7241 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7242
7243 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
7244 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
7245 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
7246 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
7247 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
7248 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
7249 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
7250 backends.
7251
7252 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
7253
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007254
7255option tcplog
7256 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007258 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007259 Arguments : none
7260
7261 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7262 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7263 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
7264 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
7265 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
7266 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
7267 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
7268 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
7269
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007270 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7271
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007272 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007273
7274
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007275option transparent
7276no option transparent
7277 Enable client-side transparent proxying
7278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01007279 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007280 Arguments : none
7281
7282 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
7283 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
7284 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
7285 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
7286 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
7287 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
7288 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
7289 appropriate server.
7290
7291 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
7292 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
7293
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01007294 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007295 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007296
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007297
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007298external-check command <command>
7299 Executable to run when performing an external-check
7300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7301 yes | no | yes | yes
7302
7303 Arguments :
7304 <command> is the external command to run
7305
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007306 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
7307
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007308 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007309
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01007310 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
7311 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
7312 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
7313 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
7314 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
7315 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007316
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01007317 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
7318
7319 Environment variables :
7320 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
7321 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
7322
7323 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
7324
7325 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
7326
7327 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
7328 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
7329 for a UNIX socket).
7330
7331 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
7332
7333 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
7334
7335 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
7336
7337 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
7338
7339 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
7340
7341 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
7342 socket).
7343
7344 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
7345 the command may be set using "external-check path".
7346
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007347 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
7348 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
7349 failed.
7350
7351 Example :
7352 external-check command /bin/true
7353
7354 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
7355
7356
7357external-check path <path>
7358 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
7359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7360 yes | no | yes | yes
7361
7362 Arguments :
7363 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
7364
7365 The default path is "".
7366
7367 Example :
7368 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
7369
7370 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
7371 "external-check command"
7372
7373
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007374persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02007375persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007376 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
7377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7378 yes | no | yes | yes
7379 Arguments :
7380 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007381 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
7382 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007383
7384 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
7385 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007386 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007387 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
7388 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
7389 forwarded to this server.
7390
7391 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
7392 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
7393 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007394 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007395 a single "listen" section.
7396
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02007397 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
7398 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
7399 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
7400
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007401 Example :
7402 listen tse-farm
7403 bind :3389
7404 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
7405 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
7406 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
7407 # apply RDP cookie persistence
7408 persist rdp-cookie
7409 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02007410 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007411 balance rdp-cookie
7412 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
7413 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
7414
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09007415 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
7416 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02007417
7418
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007419rate-limit sessions <rate>
7420 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
7421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7422 yes | yes | yes | no
7423 Arguments :
7424 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
7425 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
7426
7427 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
7428 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
7429 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
7430 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
7431 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
7432 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
7433
7434 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
7435 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
7436 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
7437 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
7438
7439 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
7440 listen smtp
7441 mode tcp
7442 bind :25
7443 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02007444 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007445
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02007446 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
7447 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
7448 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01007449
7450 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
7451
7452
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007453redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7454redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
7455redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007456 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
7457 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7458 no | yes | yes | yes
7459
7460 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01007461 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007462
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007463 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007464 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007465 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
7466 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
7467 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007468
7469 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
7470 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
7471 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
7472 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
7473 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007474 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
7475 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
7476 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
7477 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007478
7479 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
7480 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
7481 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
7482 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
7483 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
7484 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007485 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007486 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007487 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
7488 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
7489 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007490
7491 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007492 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
7493 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
7494 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02007495 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01007496 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
7497 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
7498 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
7499 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007500
7501 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007502 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007503
7504 - "drop-query"
7505 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
7506 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
7507 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
7508 with a location-type redirect.
7509
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007510 - "append-slash"
7511 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7512 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7513 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7514 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7515
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007516 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7517 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7518 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7519 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7520 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7521 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7522 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7523
7524 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7525 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7526 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7527 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7528 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7529 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7530 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007531
7532 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7533 acl clear dst_port 80
7534 acl secure dst_port 8080
7535 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007536 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007537 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007538 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7539
7540 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007541 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7542 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7543 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007544 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007545
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007546 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7547 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7548 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7549
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007550 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007551 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007552
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007553 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007554 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7555 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7556 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007557
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007558 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007559
7560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007561redisp (deprecated)
7562redispatch (deprecated)
7563 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7564 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7565 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007566 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007567
7568 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7569 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7570 be able to access the service anymore.
7571
7572 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7573 redistribute them to a working server.
7574
7575 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7576 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7577 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007578
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007579 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7580 "option redispatch" instead.
7581
7582 See also : "option redispatch"
7583
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007584
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007585reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007586 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7588 no | yes | yes | yes
7589 Arguments :
7590 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7591 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007592 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007593
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007594 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7595 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7596
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007597 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7598 the last header of an HTTP request.
7599
7600 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7601 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7602 responses.
7603
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007604 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7605 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7606 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7607
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007608 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7609 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007610
7611
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007612reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7613reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007614 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7616 no | yes | yes | yes
7617 Arguments :
7618 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7619 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7620 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7621 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7622 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7623 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7624 ignores case.
7625
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007626 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7627 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7628
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007629 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7630 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7631 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7632 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007633 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007634
7635 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7636 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7637
7638 Example :
7639 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7640 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7641 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7642
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007643 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7644 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007645
7646
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007647reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7648reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007649 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7651 no | yes | yes | yes
7652 Arguments :
7653 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7654 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7655 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7656 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7657 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7658 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7659
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007660 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7661 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7662
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007663 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7664 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7665 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7666 next servers.
7667
7668 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7669 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7670 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7671
7672 Example :
7673 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7674 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7675 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7676
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007677 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7678 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007679
7680
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007681reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7682reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007683 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7685 no | yes | yes | yes
7686 Arguments :
7687 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7688 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7689 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7690 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7691 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7692 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7693 case.
7694
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007695 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7696 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7697
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007698 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7699 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7700 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7701 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007702 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007703
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007704 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007705 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007706 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007707
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007708 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7709 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7710
7711 Example :
7712 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7713 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7714 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7715
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007716 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7717 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007718
7719
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007720reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7721reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007722 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7724 no | yes | yes | yes
7725 Arguments :
7726 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7727 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7728 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7729 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7730 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7731 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7732 case.
7733
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007734 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7735 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7736
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007737 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7738 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7739 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7740 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7741
7742 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7743 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7744
7745 Example :
7746 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7747 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7748 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7749 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7750
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007751 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7752 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007753
7754
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007755reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7756reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007757 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7759 no | yes | yes | yes
7760 Arguments :
7761 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7762 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7763 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7764 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7765 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7766 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7767
7768 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7769 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7770 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7771 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007772 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007773
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007774 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7775 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7776
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007777 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7778 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7779 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7780
7781 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7782 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7783 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7784 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7785 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7786
7787 Example :
7788 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007789 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007790 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7791 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7792
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007793 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7794 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007795
7796
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007797reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7798reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007799 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7801 no | yes | yes | yes
7802 Arguments :
7803 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7804 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7805 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7806 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7807 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7808 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7809 ignores case.
7810
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007811 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7812 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7813
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007814 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7815 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007816 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7817 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7818 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007819 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7820 not set.
7821
7822 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7823 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7824 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7825 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7826 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7827
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007828 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007829 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavor of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007830 # block all others.
7831 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7832 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7833
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007834 # block bad guys
7835 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7836 reqitarpit . if badguys
7837
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007838 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7839 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007840
7841
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007842retries <value>
7843 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7844 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7845 yes | no | yes | yes
7846 Arguments :
7847 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7848 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7849 default value is 3.
7850
7851 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7852 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7853 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7854
7855 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007856 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7857 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007858
7859 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7860 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7861
7862 See also : "option redispatch"
7863
7864
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007865rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007866 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7868 no | yes | yes | yes
7869 Arguments :
7870 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7871 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007872 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007873
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007874 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7875 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7876
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007877 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7878 the last header of an HTTP response.
7879
7880 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7881 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7882 responses.
7883
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007884 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7885 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007886
7887
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007888rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7889rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007890 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7891 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7892 no | yes | yes | yes
7893 Arguments :
7894 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7895 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7896 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7897 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7898 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7899 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7900 ignores case.
7901
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007902 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7903 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7904
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007905 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7906 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007907 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007908 client.
7909
7910 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7911 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7912 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7913
7914 Example :
7915 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007916 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007917
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007918 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7919 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007920
7921
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007922rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7923rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007924 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7926 no | yes | yes | yes
7927 Arguments :
7928 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7929 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7930 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7931 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7932 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7933 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7934 ignores case.
7935
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007936 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7937 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7938
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007939 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7940 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7941 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7942 case-sensitive.
7943
7944 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007945 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7946 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7947 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007948
7949 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7950 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7951
7952 Example :
7953 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7954 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7955
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007956 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7957 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007958
7959
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007960rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7961rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007962 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7964 no | yes | yes | yes
7965 Arguments :
7966 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7967 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7968 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7969 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7970 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7971 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7972 ignores case.
7973
7974 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7975 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7976 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7977 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007978 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007979
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007980 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7981 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7982
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007983 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7984 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7985 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7986
7987 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7988 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7989 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7990 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7991 are not case-sensitive.
7992
7993 Example :
7994 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7995 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7996
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007997 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7998 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007999
8000
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008001server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008002 Declare a server in a backend
8003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8004 no | no | yes | yes
8005 Arguments :
8006 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008007 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008008 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008009
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01008010 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
8011 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
8012 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
8013 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02008014 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
8015 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
8016 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
8017 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
8018 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008019 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
8020 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
8021 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
8022 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
8023 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8024 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8025 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008026 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02008027 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
8028 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
8029 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
8030 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
8031 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
8032 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008033 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8034 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01008035 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
8036 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008037
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02008038 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008039 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
8040 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
8041 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
8042 adding this value to the client's port.
8043
8044 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
8045 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008046 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008047
8048 Examples :
8049 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
8050 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008051 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008052 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
8053 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
8054 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008055
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02008056 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
8057 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
8058 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
8059 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
8060 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
8061
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008062 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
8063 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008064
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008065server-state-file-name [<file>]
8066 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
8067 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
8068 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
8069 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
8070 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
8071 global directive "server-state-file-base".
8072
8073 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
8074 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
8075
8076 global
8077 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
8078
8079 backend bk
8080 load-server-state-from-file
8081
8082 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
8083 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008084
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02008085server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
8086 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
8087 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
8088 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8089 no | no | yes | yes
8090
8091 Arguments:
8092 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
8093
8094 <num | range>
8095 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
8096 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
8097 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
8098 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
8099
8100 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
8101
8102 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
8103
8104 <params*>
8105 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
8106 keyword.
8107
8108 Examples:
8109 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
8110 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
8111 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
8112
8113 # or
8114 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
8115
8116 # would be equivalent to:
8117 server srv1 google.com:80 check
8118 server srv2 google.com:80 check
8119 server srv3 google.com:80 check
8120
8121
8122
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008123source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008124source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008125source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008126 Set the source address for outgoing connections
8127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8128 yes | no | yes | yes
8129 Arguments :
8130 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
8131 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008132
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008133 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01008134 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
8135 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
8136 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
8137 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
8138 supported prefixes are :
8139 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
8140 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
8141 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02008142 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02008143 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8144 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008145
8146 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
8147 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02008148 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
8149 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
8150 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008151
8152 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
8153 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
8154 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
8155 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
8156 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
8157 <addr>.
8158
8159 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
8160 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
8161 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
8162 port.
8163
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008164 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
8165 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
8166 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
8167 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01008168 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008169 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
8170 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
8171 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
8172 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
8173 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
8174 HTTP header.
8175
8176 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
8177 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008178 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008179 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
8180 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
8181 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
8182 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
8183 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
8184 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
8185 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
8186
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01008187 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
8188 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
8189 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
8190 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
8191 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
8192 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
8193
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008194 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
8195 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
8196 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
8197 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
8198
8199 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
8200 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
8201 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
8202 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
8203 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
8204 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
8205
8206 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
8207 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
8208 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
8209 there are two methods :
8210
8211 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
8212 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
8213 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
8214 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
8215 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
8216 of the client ranges may be used.
8217
8218 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
8219 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
8220 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
8221 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
8222 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
8223 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
8224 same session.
8225
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008226 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
8227 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
8228 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008229 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008230
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02008231 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
8232
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008233 Examples :
8234 backend private
8235 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
8236 source 192.168.1.200
8237
8238 backend transparent_ssl1
8239 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
8240 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8241
8242 backend transparent_ssl2
8243 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
8244 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
8245 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
8246
8247 backend transparent_ssl3
8248 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
8249 # is more conntrack-friendly.
8250 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
8251
8252 backend transparent_smtp
8253 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
8254 # with Tproxy version 4.
8255 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
8256
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02008257 backend transparent_http
8258 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
8259 # proxy.
8260 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
8261
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008262 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008263 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
8264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008265
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008266srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
8267 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
8268 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8269 yes | no | yes | yes
8270 Arguments :
8271 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
8272 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
8273 as explained at the top of this document.
8274
8275 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
8276 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
8277 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
8278 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
8279 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
8280 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
8281 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
8282
8283 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
8284 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
8285 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
8286 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
8287 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008288 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008289 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008290 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008291
8292 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
8293 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
8294 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
8295 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
8296 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
8297 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
8298
8299 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
8300 Please use "timeout server" instead.
8301
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008302 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
8303 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008304
8305
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008306stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
8307 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
8308 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008309 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008310
8311 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
8312 matched.
8313
8314 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
8315 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
8316
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008317 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8318 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008319 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008320
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01008321 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
8322 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
8323 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
8324 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008325
8326 Example :
8327 # statistics admin level only for localhost
8328 backend stats_localhost
8329 stats enable
8330 stats admin if LOCALHOST
8331
8332 Example :
8333 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
8334 backend stats_auth
8335 stats enable
8336 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
8337 stats admin if TRUE
8338
8339 Example :
8340 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
8341 userlist stats-auth
8342 group admin users admin
8343 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
8344 group readonly users haproxy
8345 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
8346
8347 backend stats_auth
8348 stats enable
8349 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
8350 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
8351 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
8352 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
8353
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008354 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
8355 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8356 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02008357
8358
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008359stats auth <user>:<passwd>
8360 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
8361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008362 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008363 Arguments :
8364 <user> is a user name to grant access to
8365
8366 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
8367
8368 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
8369 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
8370 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
8371 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
8372 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
8373 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
8374
8375 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
8376 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
8377 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008378 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008379
8380 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
8381 report using "stats scope".
8382
8383 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8384 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8385 unobvious parameters.
8386
8387 Example :
8388 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8389 backend public_www
8390 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8391 stats enable
8392 stats hide-version
8393 stats scope .
8394 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008395 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008396 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8397 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8398
8399 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8400 backend private_monitoring
8401 stats enable
8402 stats uri /admin?stats
8403 stats refresh 5s
8404
8405 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
8406
8407
8408stats enable
8409 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
8410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008411 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008412 Arguments : none
8413
8414 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
8415 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
8416 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
8417 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
8418 - stats auth : no authentication
8419 - stats scope : no restriction
8420
8421 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8422 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8423 unobvious parameters.
8424
8425 Example :
8426 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8427 backend public_www
8428 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8429 stats enable
8430 stats hide-version
8431 stats scope .
8432 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008433 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008434 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8435 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8436
8437 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8438 backend private_monitoring
8439 stats enable
8440 stats uri /admin?stats
8441 stats refresh 5s
8442
8443 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8444
8445
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008446stats hide-version
8447 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008449 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008450 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008451
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008452 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
8453 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
8454 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
8455 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
8456 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
8457 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008459 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8460 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8461 unobvious parameters.
8462
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008463 Example :
8464 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8465 backend public_www
8466 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02008467 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008468 stats hide-version
8469 stats scope .
8470 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008471 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008472 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8473 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008474
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008475 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8476 backend private_monitoring
8477 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008478 stats uri /admin?stats
8479 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01008480
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008481 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02008482
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01008483
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02008484stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
8485 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8486 Access control for statistics
8487
8488 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8489 no | no | yes | yes
8490
8491 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
8492 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
8493 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
8494 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
8495 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
8496 should be asked to enter a username and password.
8497
8498 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
8499 instance.
8500
8501 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
8502 about ACL usage.
8503
8504
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008505stats realm <realm>
8506 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
8507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008508 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008509 Arguments :
8510 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
8511 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
8512 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
8513
8514 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
8515 using a backslash ('\').
8516
8517 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8518 only related to authentication.
8519
8520 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8521 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8522 unobvious parameters.
8523
8524 Example :
8525 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8526 backend public_www
8527 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8528 stats enable
8529 stats hide-version
8530 stats scope .
8531 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008532 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008533 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8534 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8535
8536 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8537 backend private_monitoring
8538 stats enable
8539 stats uri /admin?stats
8540 stats refresh 5s
8541
8542 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8543
8544
8545stats refresh <delay>
8546 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008548 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008549 Arguments :
8550 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8551 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8552 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8553 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8554 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8555 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8556
8557 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8558 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8559 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8560 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8561
8562 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8563 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8564 unobvious parameters.
8565
8566 Example :
8567 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8568 backend public_www
8569 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8570 stats enable
8571 stats hide-version
8572 stats scope .
8573 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008574 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008575 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8576 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8577
8578 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8579 backend private_monitoring
8580 stats enable
8581 stats uri /admin?stats
8582 stats refresh 5s
8583
8584 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8585
8586
8587stats scope { <name> | "." }
8588 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008590 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008591 Arguments :
8592 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8593 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8594 section in which the statement appears.
8595
8596 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8597 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8598 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8599 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8600 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8601 exists.
8602
8603 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8604 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8605 unobvious parameters.
8606
8607 Example :
8608 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8609 backend public_www
8610 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8611 stats enable
8612 stats hide-version
8613 stats scope .
8614 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008615 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008616 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8617 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8618
8619 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8620 backend private_monitoring
8621 stats enable
8622 stats uri /admin?stats
8623 stats refresh 5s
8624
8625 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8626
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008627
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008628stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008629 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008632
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008633 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008634 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8635
8636 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8637 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8638
8639 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8640 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008641 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008642
8643 Example :
8644 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8645 backend private_monitoring
8646 stats enable
8647 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8648 stats uri /admin?stats
8649 stats refresh 5s
8650
8651 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8652 global section.
8653
8654
8655stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008656 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8658 yes | yes | yes | yes
8659 Arguments : none
8660
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008661 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008662 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8663 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8664 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8665 - IP (socket, server)
8666 - cookie (backend, server)
8667
8668 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8669 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008670 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008671
8672 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8673
8674
8675stats show-node [ <name> ]
8676 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008678 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008679 Arguments:
8680 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8681 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8682
8683 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8684 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008685 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008686
8687 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8688 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8689 unobvious parameters.
8690
8691 Example:
8692 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8693 backend private_monitoring
8694 stats enable
8695 stats show-node Europe-1
8696 stats uri /admin?stats
8697 stats refresh 5s
8698
8699 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8700 section.
8701
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008702
8703stats uri <prefix>
8704 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008706 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008707 Arguments :
8708 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8709 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8710 query string.
8711
8712 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8713 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8714 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8715 possible to reach it in the application.
8716
8717 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008718 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008719 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8720 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8721 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8722 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8723
8724 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8725 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8726 an address or a port to statistics only.
8727
8728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8730 unobvious parameters.
8731
8732 Example :
8733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8734 backend public_www
8735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8736 stats enable
8737 stats hide-version
8738 stats scope .
8739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8743
8744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8745 backend private_monitoring
8746 stats enable
8747 stats uri /admin?stats
8748 stats refresh 5s
8749
8750 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8751
8752
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008753stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8754 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008756 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008757
8758 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008759 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008760 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008761 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008762 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8763
8764 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8765 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8766 the "stick-table" statement.
8767
8768 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8769 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8770 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8771 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8772 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8773
8774 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8775 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8776 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8777 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8778 transformation rules.
8779
8780 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8781 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8782 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8783 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8784 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8785 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8786 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8787
8788 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8789 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8790 ACL based conditions.
8791
8792 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8793 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8794 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8795 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8796
8797 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8798 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8799 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8800 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8801
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008802 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8803 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008804 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008805
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008806 Example :
8807 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8808 # last 30 minutes
8809 backend pop
8810 mode tcp
8811 balance roundrobin
8812 stick store-request src
8813 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8814 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8815 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8816
8817 backend smtp
8818 mode tcp
8819 balance roundrobin
8820 stick match src table pop
8821 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8822 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8823
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008824 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008825 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008826
8827
8828stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8829 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8831 no | no | yes | yes
8832
8833 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8834 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8835 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8836 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8837
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008838 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8839 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008840 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008841
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008842 Examples :
8843 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008844 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008845
8846 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8847 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8848 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8849
8850
8851 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8852 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8853 backend http
8854 mode http
8855 balance roundrobin
8856 stick on src table https
8857 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8858 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8859 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8860
8861 backend https
8862 mode tcp
8863 balance roundrobin
8864 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8865 stick on src
8866 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8867 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8868
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008869 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008870
8871
8872stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8873 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8874 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8875 no | no | yes | yes
8876
8877 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008878 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008879 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008880 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008881 server is selected.
8882
8883 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8884 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8885 the "stick-table" statement.
8886
8887 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8888 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8889 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8890 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8891 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8892 address.
8893
8894 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8895 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8896 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8897 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8898 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8899 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8900 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8901 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8902 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8903 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8904
8905 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8906 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8907 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8908 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8909 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8910 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8911 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8912
8913 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8914 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8915 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8916 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8917
8918 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8919 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8920 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8921 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8922 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8923 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008924 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8925 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8926 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8927 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8928 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8929 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008930
8931 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8932 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8933 the request.
8934
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008935 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8936 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008937 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008938
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008939 Example :
8940 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8941 # last 30 minutes
8942 backend pop
8943 mode tcp
8944 balance roundrobin
8945 stick store-request src
8946 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8947 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8948 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8949
8950 backend smtp
8951 mode tcp
8952 balance roundrobin
8953 stick match src table pop
8954 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8955 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8956
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008957 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008958 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008959
8960
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008961stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008962 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8963 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008964 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008965 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008966 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008967
8968 Arguments :
8969 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8970 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8971 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8972 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8973
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008974 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8975 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8976 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8977 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8978
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008979 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8980 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8981 instance.
8982
8983 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8984 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8985 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8986 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8987 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8988 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008989 to 32 characters.
8990
8991 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8992 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8993 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008994 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008995 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8996 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008997
8998 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008999 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
9000 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009001 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
9002 increase.
9003
9004 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009005 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
9006 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
9007 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009008
9009 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
9010 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
9011 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
9012 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009013 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009014 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
9015 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
9016 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
9017 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
9018 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
9019 parameter (see below).
9020
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02009021 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
9022 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
9023 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
9024 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
9025 soft restart.
9026
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02009027 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
9028 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009029
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009030 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
9031 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
9032 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
9033 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009034 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009035 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009036 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
9037 if not expiration delay is specified.
9038
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009039 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
9040 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
9041 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
9042 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009043 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
9044 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
9045 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
9046 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
9047 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
9048 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
9049 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
9050 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
9051 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
9052 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
9053 types and their arguments.
9054
9055 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
9056 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
9057 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
9058 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
9059
9060 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9061 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9062 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009063 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009064
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009065 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
9066 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9067 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009068 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009069 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009070 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02009071
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009072 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
9073 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
9074 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
9075 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
9076
9077 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
9078 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
9079 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
9080 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
9081 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
9082 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
9083
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009084 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9085 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
9086 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
9087 they were received.
9088
9089 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9090 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
9091 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
9092 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
9093 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
9094
9095 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9096 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9097 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9098 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
9099 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9100
9101 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
9102 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
9103 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
9104
9105 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9106 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9107 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9108 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
9109 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9110
9111 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9112 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
9113 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
9114 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
9115 the client side.
9116
9117 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9118 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9119 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9120 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
9121 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
9122 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
9123 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
9124
9125 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
9126 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
9127 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
9128 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
9129 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
9130 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009131 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009132
9133 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9134 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9135 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9136 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
9137 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
9138 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
9139
9140 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009141 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009142 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
9143 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
9144
9145 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
9146 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9147 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9148 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9149 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9150 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
9151 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
9152 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
9153 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
9154 recommended for better fairness.
9155
9156 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009157 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009158 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
9159 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
9160
9161 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
9162 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
9163 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
9164 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
9165 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
9166 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
9167 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
9168 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
9169 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
9170 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02009171
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02009172 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
9173 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009174 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
9175 reference it.
9176
9177 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
9178 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01009179 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
9180 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
9181 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009182
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009183 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
9184 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
9185 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
9186 something that can be ignored.
9187
9188 Example:
9189 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
9190 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
9191 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
9192 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
9193
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +03009194 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01009195 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009196
9197
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009198stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01009199 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009200 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9201 no | no | yes | yes
9202
9203 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009204 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009205 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009206 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009207 server is selected.
9208
9209 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9210 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9211 the "stick-table" statement.
9212
9213 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9214 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9215 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
9216 when the response is a SSL server hello.
9217
9218 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9219 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
9220 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
9221 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
9222 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
9223 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009224 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009225 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
9226 rules.
9227
9228 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9229 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9230 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9231 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9232 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9233 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9234 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9235
9236 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
9237 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9238 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
9239 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9240
9241 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
9242 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9243 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9244 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9245 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9246 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009247 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
9248 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9249 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9250 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9251 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9252 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
9253 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
9254 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
9255 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009256
9257 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
9258
9259 Example :
9260 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
9261 backend https
9262 mode tcp
9263 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009264 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009265 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009266
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009267 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
9268 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
9269
9270 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
9271 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9272 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
9273
9274 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
9275 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009276
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009277 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
9278 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
9279 # at offset 44.
9280
9281 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
9282 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
9283
9284 # Learn on response if server hello.
9285 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009286
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02009287 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9288 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9289
9290 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
9291 extraction.
9292
9293
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009294tcp-check connect [params*]
9295 Opens a new connection
9296 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9297 no | no | yes | yes
9298
9299 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
9300 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
9301 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
9302
9303 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
9304 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
9305 of the sequence.
9306
9307 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
9308 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
9309 do.
9310
9311 Parameters :
9312 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
9313 use the TCP connection.
9314
9315 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
9316 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
9317 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
9318
9319 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
9320
9321 ssl opens a ciphered connection
9322
9323 Examples:
9324 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
9325 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
9326 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
9327 option tcp-check
9328 tcp-check connect
9329 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9330 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9331 tcp-check send \r\n
9332 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9333 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
9334 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
9335 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
9336 tcp-check send \r\n
9337 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
9338 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
9339
9340 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
9341 option tcp-check
9342 tcp-check connect port 110
9343 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9344 tcp-check connect port 143
9345 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9346 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
9347
9348 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
9349
9350
9351tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009352 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009353 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9354 no | no | yes | yes
9355
9356 Arguments :
9357 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
9358 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
9359 binary.
9360 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
9361 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
9362 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
9363
9364 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
9365 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
9366 with the usual backslash ('\').
9367 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009369 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
9370 used upper or lower case.
9371
9372
9373 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
9374
9375 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
9376 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9377 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
9378 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9379 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
9380 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
9381 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
9382 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
9383
9384 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
9385 A health check response will be considered valid if the
9386 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
9387 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
9388 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
9389 expression.
9390
9391 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
9392 in the response buffer. A health check response will
9393 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
9394 this exact hexadecimal string.
9395 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
9396
9397 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
9398 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
9399 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
9400 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
9401 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
9402 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
9403 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
9404 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
9405 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
9406 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
9407 the null character.
9408
9409 Examples :
9410 # perform a POP check
9411 option tcp-check
9412 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
9413
9414 # perform an IMAP check
9415 option tcp-check
9416 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
9417
9418 # look for the redis master server
9419 option tcp-check
9420 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009421 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009422 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9423 tcp-check expect string role:master
9424 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9425 tcp-check expect string +OK
9426
9427
9428 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
9429 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
9430
9431
9432tcp-check send <data>
9433 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9434 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9435 no | no | yes | yes
9436
9437 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9438 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
9439
9440 Examples :
9441 # look for the redis master server
9442 option tcp-check
9443 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9444 tcp-check expect string role:master
9445
9446 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9447 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
9448
9449
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009450tcp-check send-binary <hexstring>
9451 Specify a hex digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009452 tcp health check
9453 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9454 no | no | yes | yes
9455
9456 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
9457 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009458 <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02009459 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
9460 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
9461 hexadecimal string.
9462 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
9463
9464 Examples :
9465 # redis check in binary
9466 option tcp-check
9467 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
9468 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
9469
9470
9471 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
9472 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
9473
9474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009475tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9476 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9478 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009479 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009480 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9481 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02009482
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009483 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009484
9485 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
9486 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009487 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
9488 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
9489 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
9490 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
9491 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
9492 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009493
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009494 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9495 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9496 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
9497 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009498
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009499 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009500 - accept :
9501 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9502 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9503 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009504
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009505 - reject :
9506 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9507 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9508 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
9509 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
9510 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
9511 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
9512 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
9513 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
9514 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
9515 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
9516 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009517 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009518
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009519 - expect-proxy layer4 :
9520 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
9521 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
9522 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
9523 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
9524 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
9525 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
9526 hosts.
9527
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009528 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9529 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9530 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9531 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9532 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9533 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9534 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9535 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9536
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009537 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9538 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9539 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9540 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9541 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9542 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9543 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9544 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9545 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009546 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9547 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009548
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009549 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009550 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +02009551 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
9552 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
9553 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
9554 haproxy -vv) whichs defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
9555 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
9556 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
9557 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9558 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
9559 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
9560 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
9561 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
9562 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009563
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009564 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009565 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009566 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009567 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009568 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9569 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9570 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009571
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009572 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9573 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9574 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9575 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009576
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009577 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9578 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9579 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9580 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9581 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009582 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9583 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9584 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9585 layer7 information is extracted.
9586
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009587 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9588 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9589 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9590 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9591 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009592
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009593 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9594 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9595 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9596 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9597
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009598 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
9599 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
9600 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9601 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9602
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009603 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9604 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9605 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9606 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9607 continues.
9608
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009609 - set-src <expr> :
9610 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9611 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9612 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009613 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009614
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009615 Arguments:
9616 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9617 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009618
9619 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009620 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9621
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009622 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9623 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009624
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009625 - set-src-port <expr> :
9626 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9627 expression.
9628
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02009629 Arguments:
9630 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9631 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009632
9633 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009634 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9635
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009636 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9637 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9638 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009639
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009640 - set-dst <expr> :
9641 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9642 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9643 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9644 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9645 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9646
9647 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9648 followed by some converters.
9649
9650 Example:
9651
9652 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9653 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9654
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009655 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9656 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9657
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009658 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9659 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9660 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9661 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9662
9663
9664 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9665 followed by some converters.
9666
9667 Example:
9668
9669 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9670
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009671 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9672 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9673 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9674
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009675 - "silent-drop" :
9676 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009678 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9679 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9680 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9681 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9682 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009683 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
9684 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009685 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9686 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009687 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009688 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9689 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9690 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9691 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9692
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009693 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9694 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9695 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009696
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009697 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9698 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9699 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009700
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009701 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009702 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009703 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009704
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009705 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9706 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9707 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009708
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009709 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009710 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9711 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009712
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009713 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9714
9715 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9716
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009717 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9718
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009719 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009720
9721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009722tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9723 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009725 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009726 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009727 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9728 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009729
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009730 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009731
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009732 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009733 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9734 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9735 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9736 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009737
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009738 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9739 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9740 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9741 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009742 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9743 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9744 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9745 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9746 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9747 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009748 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009749 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009750
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009751 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9752 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9753 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9754 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009755
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009756 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009757 - accept : the request is accepted
9758 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9759 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009760 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009761 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009762 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01009763 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009764 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009765 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009766 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009767 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009768 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009769
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009770 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9771 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009772
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009773 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9774 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9775 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9776 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9777 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9778 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009780 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009781 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9782 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009783
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009784 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009785 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9786 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9787 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9788 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009789 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9790 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9791 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009792
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009793 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009794 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9795 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9796 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009797
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009798 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009799 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9800 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009801
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009802 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9803 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009804 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009805 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9806 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009807 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009808 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009809 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009810 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9811 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009812 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009813 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9814 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009815
9816 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9817 followed by some converters.
9818
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009819 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9820 <var-name>.
9821
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04009822 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
9823 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
9824 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
9825 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
9826 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
9827
9828 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
9829 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
9830 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
9831 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
9832 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
9833 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
9834 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
9835 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
9836 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
9837 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
9838 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
9839
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02009840 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
9841 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
9842 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
9843 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
9844 the SPOE agent name must be used.
9845
9846 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
9847
9848 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
9849
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009850 Example:
9851
9852 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009853 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009854
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009855 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009856 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9857 # and reject everything else.
9858 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9859 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009860 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009861 tcp-request content reject
9862
9863 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009864 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9865 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9866 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009867 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009868
9869 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9870 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9871 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009872 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009873 tcp-request content reject
9874
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009875 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009876 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009877 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009878 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009879 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9880 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009881
9882 Example:
9883 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9884 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009885 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009886
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009887 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009888 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009889
9890 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009891 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009892 # protecting all our sites
9893 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009894 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9895 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009896 ...
9897 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9898
9899 backend http_dynamic
9900 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009901 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009902 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009903 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009904 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009905 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009906 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009908 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009909
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009910 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9911 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009912
9913
9914tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9915 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009917 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009918 Arguments :
9919 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9920 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9921 as explained at the top of this document.
9922
9923 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9924 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9925 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9926 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9927 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9928
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009929 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9930 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9931 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9932 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9933
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009934 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9935 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009936 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009937 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009938 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9939 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9940 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9941 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009942
9943 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9944 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9945 it pass through unaffected.
9946
9947 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9948 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9949 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009950 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009951 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9952 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009953 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9954 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9955 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009956
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009957 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009958 "timeout client".
9959
9960
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009961tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9962 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9964 no | no | yes | yes
9965 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009966 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9967 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009968
9969 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009971 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009972 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9973 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009974 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9975 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009976
9977 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9978
9979 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9980 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9981 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9982 inserted.
9983
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009984 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009985 - accept :
9986 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9987 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9988 the rules evaluation.
9989
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009990 - close :
9991 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9992 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9993 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9994 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9995 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9996 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009997 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009998 protocols.
9999
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010000 - reject :
10001 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10002 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010003 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010004
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010005 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
10006 Sets a variable.
10007
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010008 - unset-var(<var-name>)
10009 Unsets a variable.
10010
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010011 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10012 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10013 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10014 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10015
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010016 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10017 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10018 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
10019 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
10020
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010021 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
10022 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
10023 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
10024 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
10025 continues.
10026
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010027 - "silent-drop" :
10028 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010029 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010030 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10031 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10032 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10033 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10034 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010035 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10036 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010037 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10038 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010039 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010040 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10041 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10042 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10043 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10044
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010045 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
10046 Send a group of SPOE messages.
10047
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010048 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10049 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10050 for changing the default action to a reject.
10051
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010052 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
10053 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
10054 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
10055 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010056 period.
10057
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010058 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
10059 declared inline.
10060
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010061 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
10062 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010010063 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010064 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
10065 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010066 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010068 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010010069 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
10070 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010071 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010010072 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
10073 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020010074
10075 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10076 followed by some converters.
10077
10078 Example:
10079
10080 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
10081
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010082 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
10083 <var-name>.
10084
10085 Example:
10086
10087 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
10088
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020010089 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
10090 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
10091 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
10092 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
10093 the SPOE agent name must be used.
10094
10095 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
10096
10097 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
10098
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010099 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10100
10101 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
10102
10103
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010104tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10105 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
10106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10107 no | yes | yes | no
10108 Arguments :
10109 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10110 below.
10111
10112 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
10113
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010114 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010115 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
10116 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
10117 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
10118 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
10119 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
10120 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
10121 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010122 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010123 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
10124 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
10125 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
10126 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
10127 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
10128 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
10129 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
10130 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
10131 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
10132 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
10133 instead.
10134
10135 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10136 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10137 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
10138 rules which may be inserted.
10139
10140 Several types of actions are supported :
10141 - accept : the request is accepted
10142 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10143 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
10144 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010145 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010146 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
10147 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010010148 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010149 - silent-drop
10150
10151 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
10152 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
10153 sections for a complete description.
10154
10155 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10156 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10157 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
10158
10159 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
10160 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
10161 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
10162 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
10163 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
10164
10165 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10166 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10167
10168 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10169 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
10170 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
10171
10172 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10173 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
10174 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10175
10176 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
10177 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10178 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
10179
10180 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
10181 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
10182 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
10183
10184 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10185
10186 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
10187
10188
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020010189tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
10190 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
10191 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10192 no | no | yes | yes
10193 Arguments :
10194 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10195 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10196 as explained at the top of this document.
10197
10198 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
10199
10200
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010201timeout check <timeout>
10202 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
10203 established.
10204
10205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10206 yes | no | yes | yes
10207 Arguments:
10208 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10210 as explained at the top of this document.
10211
10212 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
10213 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010214 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010215 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010010216 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
10217 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
10218 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010219
10220 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
10221 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
10222
10223 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
10224 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010225 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010226
10227 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10228 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10229 forget about it.
10230
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010231 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
10232 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010233
10234
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010235timeout client <timeout>
10236timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10237 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
10238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10239 yes | yes | yes | no
10240 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010241 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010242 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10243 as explained at the top of this document.
10244
10245 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10246 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10247 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010248 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
10249 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
10250 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
10251 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010252 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
10253 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
10254 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010255 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010256 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010257 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
10258 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010259 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
10260 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010261
10262 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10263 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10264 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10265 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10266 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10267 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10268
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010269 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010270
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010271 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
10272 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
10273 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10274
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010010275 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
10276 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010277
10278
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010279timeout client-fin <timeout>
10280 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
10281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10282 yes | yes | yes | no
10283 Arguments :
10284 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10285 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10286 as explained at the top of this document.
10287
10288 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
10289 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10290 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10291 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10292 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
10293 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10294 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010010295 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
10296 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
10297 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010298
10299 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
10300 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10301 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
10302
10303 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
10304
10305
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010306timeout connect <timeout>
10307timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10308 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
10309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10310 yes | no | yes | yes
10311 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010312 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010313 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10314 as explained at the top of this document.
10315
10316 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010317 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010318 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010319 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010010320 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
10321 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010322
10323 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10324 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10325 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10326 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10327 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
10328 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10329
10330 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
10331 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
10332 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10333
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010010334 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
10335 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010336
10337
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010338timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
10339 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
10340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10341 yes | yes | yes | yes
10342 Arguments :
10343 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10344 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10345 as explained at the top of this document.
10346
10347 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
10348 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
10349 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
10350 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
10351 once the request has started to present itself.
10352
10353 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
10354 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
10355 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
10356 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
10357 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
10358
10359 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
10360 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
10361 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
10362 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
10363
10364 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
10365 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010366 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010367 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
10368 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020010369 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010370
10371 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
10372 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
10373 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
10374 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
10375
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010376 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
10377 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010010378 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
10379
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010380 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
10381
10382
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010383timeout http-request <timeout>
10384 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
10385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010386 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010387 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010388 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010389 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10390 as explained at the top of this document.
10391
10392 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
10393 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
10394 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
10395 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
10396 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
10397 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
10398 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020010399 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
10400 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
10401 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
10402 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010403 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010404 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
10405 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010406
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010407 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
10408 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
10409 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
10410 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
10411 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010010412 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010413
10414 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
10415 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010416 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010417 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
10418 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
10419
10420 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020010421 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
10422 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
10423 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010424
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020010425 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010010426 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010427
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010428
10429timeout queue <timeout>
10430 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
10431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10432 yes | no | yes | yes
10433 Arguments :
10434 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10435 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10436 as explained at the top of this document.
10437
10438 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
10439 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
10440 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
10441 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
10442 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
10443
10444 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
10445 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
10446 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
10447 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
10448
10449 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10450
10451
10452timeout server <timeout>
10453timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
10454 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
10455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10456 yes | no | yes | yes
10457 Arguments :
10458 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10459 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10460 as explained at the top of this document.
10461
10462 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10463 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
10464 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
10465 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
10466 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
10467 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
10468 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
10469
10470 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10471 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10472 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
10473 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
10474 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010010475 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010476 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010477 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
10478 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010479 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
10480 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010481
10482 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10483 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10484 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
10485 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
10486 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
10487 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
10488
10489 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
10490 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
10491 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
10492
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010493 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010494
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010495
10496timeout server-fin <timeout>
10497 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
10498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10499 yes | no | yes | yes
10500 Arguments :
10501 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10502 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10503 as explained at the top of this document.
10504
10505 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
10506 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
10507 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
10508 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
10509 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
10510 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
10511 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
10512 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
10513 situations, it should not be needed.
10514
10515 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10516 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
10517 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
10518
10519 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
10520
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010521
10522timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010523 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10525 yes | yes | yes | yes
10526 Arguments :
10527 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
10528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10529 as explained at the top of this document.
10530
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010531 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
10532 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
10533 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
10534 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010535
10536 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10537 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10538 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
10539 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010540 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010541
10542 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
10543
10544
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010545timeout tunnel <timeout>
10546 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
10547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10548 yes | no | yes | yes
10549 Arguments :
10550 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
10551 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
10552 as explained at the top of this document.
10553
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010554 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010555 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
10556 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
10557 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010558 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
10559 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010560 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
10561 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
10562 specified.
10563
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010564 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
10565 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
10566 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
10567 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
10568 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
10569 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
10570 state.
10571
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010572 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
10573 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
10574 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
10575 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010576 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010577
10578 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
10579 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
10580 forget about it.
10581
10582 Example :
10583 defaults http
10584 option http-server-close
10585 timeout connect 5s
10586 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010587 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010588 timeout server 30s
10589 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
10590
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020010591 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010592
10593
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010594transparent (deprecated)
10595 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010597 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010598 Arguments : none
10599
10600 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10601 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10602 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10603 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10604 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10605 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10606 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10607 appropriate server.
10608
10609 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10610
10611 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10612 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10613
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010614 See also: "option transparent"
10615
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010616unique-id-format <string>
10617 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10618 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10619 yes | yes | yes | no
10620 Arguments :
10621 <string> is a log-format string.
10622
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010623 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10624 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10625 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10626 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010627
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010628 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10629 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10630 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10631 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10632 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10633 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10634 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10635 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010636
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010637 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10638 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010639
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010640 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010641
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010642 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010643
10644 will generate:
10645
10646 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10647
10648 See also: "unique-id-header"
10649
10650unique-id-header <name>
10651 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10653 yes | yes | yes | no
10654 Arguments :
10655 <name> is the name of the header.
10656
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010657 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10658 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010659
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010660 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010661
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010662 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010663 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10664
10665 will generate:
10666
10667 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10668
10669 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010670
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010671use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010672 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10674 no | yes | yes | no
10675 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010676 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10677 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010678
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010679 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10680 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010681
10682 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10683 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10684 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010685 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010686 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010687 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10688 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010689
10690 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10691 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10692 assign the backend.
10693
10694 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10695 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10696 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10697 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10698 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10699 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10700
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010701 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010702 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010703 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10704 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10705 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10706
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010707 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10708 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10709 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10710 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10711 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10712 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10713 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10714 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10715 cannot be forced from the request.
10716
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010717 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010718 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10719 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10720
10721 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10722 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010723
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010724
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010725use-server <server> if <condition>
10726use-server <server> unless <condition>
10727 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10729 no | no | yes | yes
10730 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010731 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010732
10733 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10734
10735 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10736 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10737 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10738
10739 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10740 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10741 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10742 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10743 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10744 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10745 matches will assign the server.
10746
10747 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10748 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10749 with the next rules until one matches.
10750
10751 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10752 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10753 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10754 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10755
10756 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10757 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10758 stripped.
10759
10760 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10761 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10762 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10763 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10764
10765 Example :
10766 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10767 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10768 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10769 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10770 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10771 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010772 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010773 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10774 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10775
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010776 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010777
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010778
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100107795. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010780--------------------------
10781
10782The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10783depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10784settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10785written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10786described in this section.
10787
10788
107895.1. Bind options
10790-----------------
10791
10792The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10793as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10794no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10795parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10796while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10797provided immediately after the setting name.
10798
10799The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10800
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010801accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10802 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10803 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10804 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10805 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10806 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10807 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10808 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10809 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10810 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010811 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10812 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10813 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010814
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010815accept-proxy
10816 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010817 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10818 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010819 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10820 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10821 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10822 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010823 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010824 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10825 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010826 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10827 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010828
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010829allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010010830 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010010831 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
10832 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, ie requests
10833 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
10834 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020010835
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010836alpn <protocols>
10837 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10838 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10839 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10840 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10841 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010010842 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
10843 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
10844 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
10845 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
10846 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
10847 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
10848 preference, like below :
10849
10850 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010851
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010852backlog <backlog>
10853 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10854 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10855
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010856curves <curves>
10857 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10858 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10859 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10860 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10861 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10862 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10863
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010864ecdhe <named curve>
10865 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010866 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10867 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010868
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010869ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010870 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10871 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10872 client's certificate.
10873
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010874ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10875 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10876 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10877 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10878 error is ignored.
10879
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010880ca-sign-file <cafile>
10881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10882 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10883 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10884 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10885 'generate-certificates' for details.
10886
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010887ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10889 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10890 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10891 'generate-certificates' for details.
10892
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010893ciphers <ciphers>
10894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10895 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020010896 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake except for TLSv1.3. The format of the
10897 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for
10898 instance a string such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without
10899 quotes). Depending on the compatibility and security requirements, the list
10900 of suitable ciphers depends on a variety of variables. For background
10901 information and recommendations see e.g.
10902 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
10903 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
10904 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
10905
10906ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
10907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
10908 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
10909 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
10910 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
10911 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section, and can be for instance a
10912 string such as
10913 "TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256"
10914 (without quotes). For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check
10915 the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010916
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010917crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010918 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10919 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10920 to verify client's certificate.
10921
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010922crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010923 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10924 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10925 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10926 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10927 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10928 file.
10929
10930 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10931 are loaded.
10932
10933 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010934 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010935 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10936 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10937 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10938 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010939 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10940 instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010941 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010942
10943 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10944 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10945 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10946 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010947 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10948 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010949
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010950 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010951
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010953 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010954 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
10955 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010956 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10957 clients).
10958
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010959 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10960 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10961 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10962 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10963 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10964 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10965 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10966 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10967 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10968 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10969 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10970 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10971 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10972
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010973 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10974 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10975 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10976 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10977 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10978
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010979 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10980 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10981 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10982 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010983
10984 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10985 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10986 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10987 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10988 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10989 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10990 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10991 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10992 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10993
10994 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10995
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010996 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010997 a cert bundle.
10998
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010999 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011000 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
11001 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
11002 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
11003 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
11004 provide multi-cert support.
11005
11006 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
11007
11008 Filename | CN | SAN
11009 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11010 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011011 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011012 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
11013 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
11014
11015 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
11016 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
11017 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
11018 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011019 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
11020 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
11021 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011022
11023 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
11024 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
11025
11026 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
11027 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
11028 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
11029
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011030crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011031 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011032 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011033 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000011034 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020011035
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011036crt-list <file>
11037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011038 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
11039 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011040
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011041 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
11042
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011043 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca-file", "no-ca-names",
11044 crl-file", "ecdhe", "curves", "ciphers" configuration. With BoringSSL
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011045 and Openssl >= 1.1.1 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011046 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011047
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020011048 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
11049 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
11050 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
11051 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
11052 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
11053 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
11054 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
11055 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010011056
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050011057 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020011058 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020011059 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
11060 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
11061 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050011062
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011063 crt-list file example:
11064 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011065 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011066 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010011067 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010011068
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011069defer-accept
11070 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11071 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
11072 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011073 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011074 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
11075 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
11076 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
11077 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
11078 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
11079 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
11080 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
11081
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011082expose-fd listeners
11083 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
11084 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020011085 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
11086 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011087 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020011088
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011089force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011090 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011091 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011092 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011093 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011094
11095force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011096 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011097 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011098 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011099
11100force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011101 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011102 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011103 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011104
11105force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011106 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011107 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011108 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011109
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011110force-tlsv13
11111 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
11112 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011113 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011114
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011115generate-certificates
11116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11117 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
11118 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
11119 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
11120 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
11121 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
11122 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
11123 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
11124 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
11125 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
11126 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
11127
11128 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
11129 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011130 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020011131 certificate is used many times.
11132
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011133gid <gid>
11134 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
11135 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11136 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
11137 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
11138 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11139
11140group <group>
11141 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
11142 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
11143 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
11144 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
11145 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11146
11147id <id>
11148 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
11149 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
11150 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
11151 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
11152
11153interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010011154 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
11155 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
11156 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
11157 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
11158 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
11159 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010011160 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
11161 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
11162 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
11163 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
11164 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
11165 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011166
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011167level <level>
11168 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
11169 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
11170 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011171 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011172 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
11173 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
11174 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011175 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011176 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011177 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020011178 all counters).
11179
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020011180severity-output <format>
11181 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
11182 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
11183 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
11184 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
11185 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
11186 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
11187 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
11188 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
11189 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
11190 rfc5424 convention.
11191
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011192maxconn <maxconn>
11193 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
11194 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
11195 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
11196 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
11197 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
11198 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
11199 eat all memory.
11200
11201mode <mode>
11202 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
11203 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
11204 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
11205 UNIX sockets.
11206
11207mss <maxseg>
11208 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
11209 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
11210 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
11211 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
11212 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
11213 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
11214 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
11215 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
11216 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
11217 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
11218 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
11219
11220name <name>
11221 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
11222 page.
11223
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011224namespace <name>
11225 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11226 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
11227 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11228 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11229
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011230nice <nice>
11231 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
11232 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
11233 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
11234 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
11235 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
11236 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
11237 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
11238 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
11239 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
11240 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
11241 one for an RDP socket.
11242
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020011243no-ca-names
11244 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11245 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
11246
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011247no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011248 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011249 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011250 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011251 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011252 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
11253 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011254
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011255no-tls-tickets
11256 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11257 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11258 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011259 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
11260 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020011261
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011262no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011264 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011265 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011266 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011267 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11268 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011269
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011270no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011271 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011272 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011273 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011274 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011275 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11276 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011277
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011278no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011280 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020011281 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011282 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011283 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11284 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011285
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011286no-tlsv13
11287 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11288 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
11289 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
11290 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011291 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
11292 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011293
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011294npn <protocols>
11295 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11296 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11297 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11298 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020011299 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011300 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
11301 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
11302 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
11303 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
11304 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020011305
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011306prefer-client-ciphers
11307 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
11308 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
11309 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020011310 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
11311 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
11312 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000011313
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011314process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
11315 This restricts the list of processes and/or threads on which this listener is
11316 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011317 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011318 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
11319 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
11320 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
11321 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011322 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010011323 connections for this listener, for the corresponding process set. For the
11324 unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
11325 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
11326
11327 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
11328
11329 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
11330 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
11331 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
11332 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
11333 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
11334 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
11335 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
11336 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020011337
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011338proto <name>
11339 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
11340 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
11341 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
11342 in haproxy -vv.
11343 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
11344 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080011345 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020011346 h2" on the bind line.
11347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011348ssl
11349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011350 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011351 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
11352 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020011353 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
11354 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011355
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011356ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11357 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
11358 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11359 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11360
11361ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11362 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
11363 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
11364 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11365
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010011366strict-sni
11367 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
11368 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
11369 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
11370 See the "crt" option for more information.
11371
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011372tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011373 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011374 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
11375 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011376 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010011377 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
11378 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
11379 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
11380 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
11381 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
11382 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
11383 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11384
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011385tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010011386 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011387 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
11388 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
11389 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
11390 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
11391 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
11392 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
11393 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020011394 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
11395 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
11396 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020011397
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011398tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
11399 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010011400 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
11401 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
11402 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
11403 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
11404 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
11405 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
11406 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
11407 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
11408 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
11409 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010011410 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
11411 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
11412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011413transparent
11414 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
11415 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
11416 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
11417 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
11418 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
11419 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
11420 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
11421 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
11422 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
11423 so check for support with your vendor.
11424
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011425v4v6
11426 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11427 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
11428 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
11429 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011430 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011431
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011432v6only
11433 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
11434 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
11435 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010011436 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
11437 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010011438
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011439uid <uid>
11440 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
11441 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11442 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
11443 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
11444 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11445
11446user <user>
11447 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
11448 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
11449 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
11450 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
11451 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
11452
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020011453verify [none|optional|required]
11454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
11455 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
11456 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
11457 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
11458 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020011459 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
11460 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
11461 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
11462 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011463
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200114645.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010011465------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011467The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
11468which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
11469arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
11470settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
11471after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
11472Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
11473address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011474
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011475 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010011476 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011477
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011478Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
11479keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
11480
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011481The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011482
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020011483addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011484 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010011485 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
11486 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
11487 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
11488 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
11489 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011490
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011491agent-check
11492 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011493 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010011494 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
11495 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
11496 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011497
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011498 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011499 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020011500 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
11501 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
11502 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011503
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011504 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
11505 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
11506 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
11507 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
11508 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020011509
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011510 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011511 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011512
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011513 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11514 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
11515 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011516
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011517 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
11518 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
11519 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011520
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011521 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
11522 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
11523 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
11524 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
11525 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011526 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011527 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011528
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011529 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
11530 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011531
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011532 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
11533 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
11534 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
11535 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
11536 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
11537 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
11538 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
11539 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
11540 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011541
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011542 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
11543 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011544 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
11545 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
11546 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010011547 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090011548
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010011549 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011550 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011551
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070011552agent-send <string>
11553 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
11554 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
11555 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
11556 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
11557 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
11558
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011559agent-inter <delay>
11560 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
11561 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11562
11563 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
11564 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
11565 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
11566 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
11567 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11568 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11569 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11570 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11571 of backends use the same servers.
11572
11573 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
11574
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010011575agent-addr <addr>
11576 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
11577
11578 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
11579 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
11580 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
11581 hostname, it will be resolved.
11582
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011583agent-port <port>
11584 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
11585
11586 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
11587
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011588alpn <protocols>
11589 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
11590 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
11591 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
11592 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
11593 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
11594 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
11595 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
11596 now obsolete NPN extension.
11597 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
11598 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
11599
11600 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
11601
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011602backup
11603 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
11604 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
11605 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
11606 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011607 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
11608 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011609
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011610ca-file <cafile>
11611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11612 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
11613 server's certificate.
11614
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011615check
11616 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010011617 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
11618 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
11619 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
11620 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
11621 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
11622 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
11623 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090011624 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
11625 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011626 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
11627 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011628
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020011629check-send-proxy
11630 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
11631 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
11632 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
11633 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
11634 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
11635 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
11636 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
11637
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010011638check-alpn <protocols>
11639 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
11640 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
11641 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11642
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011643check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011644 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010011645 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
11646 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020011647
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011648check-ssl
11649 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
11650 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
11651 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
11652 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011653 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011654 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
11655 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011656 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011657 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
11658 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011659
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011660ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011661 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
11662 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
11663 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011664 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
11665 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
11666 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
11667 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
11668 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
11669 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
11670
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020011671ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
11672 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
11673 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
11674 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
11675 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
11676 "man 1 ciphers" under the "ciphersuites" section.
11677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011678cookie <value>
11679 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
11680 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
11681 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
11682 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
11683 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
11684 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
11685 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
11686
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011687crl-file <crlfile>
11688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11689 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
11690 to verify server's certificate.
11691
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020011692crt <cert>
11693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
11694 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
11695 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
11696 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
11697 certificate request.
11698
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011699disabled
11700 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
11701 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
11702 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
11703 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
11704 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011705 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011706
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011707enabled
11708 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11709 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11710 default value.
11711 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11712 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011713
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011714error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011715 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11716 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11717 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011718
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011719 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011720
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011721fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11723 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11724 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11725
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011726force-sslv3
11727 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11728 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011729 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011730 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011731
11732force-tlsv10
11733 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011734 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011735 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011736
11737force-tlsv11
11738 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011739 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011740 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011741
11742force-tlsv12
11743 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011744 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011745 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011746
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011747force-tlsv13
11748 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11749 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011750 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011752id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011753 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11754 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11755 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011756
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011757init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11758 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11759 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011760 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011761 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11762 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11763 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11764 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11765 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11766 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11767 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11768 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11769 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011770 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011771 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11772 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11773 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11774 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11775 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11776 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011777 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011778
11779 Example:
11780 defaults
11781 # never fail on address resolution
11782 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11783
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011784inter <delay>
11785fastinter <delay>
11786downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011787 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11788 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11789 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11790 between checks depending on the server state :
11791
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011792 Server state | Interval used
11793 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11794 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11795 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11796 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11797 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11798 or yet unchecked. |
11799 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11800 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11801 | "inter" otherwise.
11802 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011803
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011804 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11805 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11806 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11807 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011808 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11809 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11810 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11811 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11812 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011813
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011814maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011815 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11816 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11817 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11818 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11819 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11820 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11821 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11822 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011824maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011825 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11826 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11827 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11828 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11829 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11830 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11831 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11832
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010011833max-reuse <count>
11834 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
11835 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
11836 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
11837 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
11838 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
11839 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
11840 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
11841 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
11842
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011843minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011844 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11845 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11846 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11847 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11848 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11849 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011850 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011851 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011852
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011853namespace <name>
11854 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11855 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11856 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11857 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11858
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011859no-agent-check
11860 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11861 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11862 default value.
11863 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11864 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11865
11866no-backup
11867 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11868 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11869 default value.
11870 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11871 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11872
11873no-check
11874 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11875 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11876 default value.
11877 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11878 "default-server" "check" setting.
11879
11880no-check-ssl
11881 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11882 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11883 default value.
11884 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11885 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11886
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011887no-send-proxy
11888 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11889 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11890 default value.
11891 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11892 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11893
11894no-send-proxy-v2
11895 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11896 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11897 default value.
11898 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11899 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11900
11901no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11902 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11903 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11904 default value.
11905 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11906 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11907
11908no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11909 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11910 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11911 default value.
11912 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11913 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11914
11915no-ssl
11916 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11917 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11918 default value.
11919 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11920 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11921
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011922no-ssl-reuse
11923 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11924 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11925 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11926 and for paranoid users.
11927
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011928no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011929 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11930 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011931 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011932
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011933 Supported in default-server: No
11934
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011935no-tls-tickets
11936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11937 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11938 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011939 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11940 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011941 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011942
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011943no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011944 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011945 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11946 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011947 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11948 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011949 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011950
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011951 Supported in default-server: No
11952
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011953no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011954 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011955 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11956 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011957 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11958 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011959 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011960
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011961 Supported in default-server: No
11962
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011963no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011964 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011965 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11966 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011967 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11968 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011969 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011970
11971 Supported in default-server: No
11972
11973no-tlsv13
11974 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11975 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11976 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11977 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11978 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011979 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011980
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011981 Supported in default-server: No
11982
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011983no-verifyhost
11984 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11985 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11986 default value.
11987 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11988 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011989
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011990non-stick
11991 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11992 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11993 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11994
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010011995npn <protocols>
11996 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
11997 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
11998 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11999 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
12000 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
12001 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12002 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
12003
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012004observe <mode>
12005 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
12006 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
12007 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
12008 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
12009 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
12010 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010012011 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012012
12013 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
12014
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012015on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010012016 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
12017 Currently, four modes are available:
12018 - fastinter: force fastinter
12019 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
12020 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
12021 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
12022 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
12023
12024 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
12025
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012026on-marked-down <action>
12027 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
12028 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012029 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
12030 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
12031 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
12032 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
12033 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
12034 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
12035 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
12036 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090012037
12038 Actions are disabled by default
12039
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012040on-marked-up <action>
12041 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
12042 Currently one action is available:
12043 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
12044 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
12045 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
12046 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012047 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
12048 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070012049 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
12050 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
12051
12052 Actions are disabled by default
12053
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010012054pool-max-conn <max>
12055 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
12056 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
12057 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
12058 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
12059 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
12060 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
12061
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010012062pool-purge-delay <delay>
12063 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
12064 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means it's never purged. The default is
12065 1s.
12066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012067port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012068 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
12069 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
12070 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
12071 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
12072 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
12073 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
12074
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020012075proto <name>
12076
12077 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
12078 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
12079 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
12080 reported in haproxy -vv.
12081 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12082 protocol for all connections established to this server.
12083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012084redir <prefix>
12085 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
12086 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
12087 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
12088 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
12089 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
12090 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
12091 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
12092 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012093 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012094 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012095 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
12096 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
12097 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
12098 loop between the client and HAProxy!
12099
12100 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
12101
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012102rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012103 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
12104 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
12105 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
12106
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020012107resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
12108 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
12109 server.
12110
12111 Available options:
12112
12113 * allow-dup-ip
12114 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
12115 resolution at runtime is in operation.
12116 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
12117 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
12118 For such case, simply enable this option.
12119 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
12120
12121 * prevent-dup-ip
12122 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
12123 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
12124 same fqdn.
12125 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
12126
12127 Example:
12128 backend b_myapp
12129 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
12130 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12131 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
12132
12133 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
12134 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
12135 it
12136 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
12137 different address
12138
12139 Default value: not set
12140
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012141resolve-prefer <family>
12142 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
12143 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
12144 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
12145 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
12146
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020012147 Default value: ipv6
12148
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012149 Example:
12150
12151 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012152
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012153resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
12154 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
12155 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012156 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012157 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
12158 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012159 configured network, another address is selected.
12160
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012161 Example:
12162
12163 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010012164
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012165resolvers <id>
12166 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
12167 hostname.
12168
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012169 Example:
12170
12171 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012172
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012173 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012174
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012175send-proxy
12176 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
12177 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
12178 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
12179 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012180 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
12181 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
12182 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
12183 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
12184 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
12185 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
12186 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
12187 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
12188 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
12189 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012190 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
12191 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010012192
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012193send-proxy-v2
12194 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
12195 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12196 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12197 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020012198 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
12199 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
12200 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
12201 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012202
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012203proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
12204 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add option to send in PROXY protocol version
12205 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are "ssl" (see also
Emmanuel Hocdetfa8d0f12018-02-01 15:53:52 +010012206 send-proxy-v2-ssl), "cert-cn" (see also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"), "ssl-cipher":
12207 name of the used cipher, "cert-sig": signature algorithm of the used
Emmanuel Hocdet253c3b72018-02-01 18:29:59 +010012208 certificate, "cert-key": key algorithm of the used certificate), "authority":
12209 host name value passed by the client (only sni from a tls connection is
Emmanuel Hocdet4399c752018-02-05 15:26:43 +010012210 supported), "crc32c": checksum of the proxy protocol v2 header.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010012211
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012212send-proxy-v2-ssl
12213 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12214 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12215 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12216 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12217 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12218 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
12219 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012220 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
12221 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012222
12223send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
12224 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
12225 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
12226 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
12227 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
12228 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
12229 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
12230 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
12231 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012232 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
12233 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040012234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012235slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012236 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
12237 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
12238 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
12239 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
12240 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
12241 parameters :
12242
12243 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
12244 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
12245
12246 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
12247 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
12248 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
12249 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
12250
12251 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
12252 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
12253 seen as failed.
12254
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012255sni <expression>
12256 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
12257 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
12258 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
12259 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020012260 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
12261 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012262 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010012263 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
12264 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020012265
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012266source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020012267source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012268source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012269 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
12270 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
12271 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
12272 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
12273
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020012274 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
12275 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
12276 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
12277 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
12278 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
12279 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
12280 server.
12281
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000012282 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
12283 specifying the source address without port(s).
12284
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012285ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020012286 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
12287 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
12288 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
12289 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
12290 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
12291 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012292 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
12293 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012294
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012295ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12296 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
12297 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12298 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12299
12300ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12301 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
12302 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
12303 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
12304
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012305ssl-reuse
12306 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
12307 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12308 default value.
12309 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12310 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
12311
12312stick
12313 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
12314 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12315 default value.
12316 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12317 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012318
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012319tcp-ut <delay>
12320 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
12321 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
12322 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012323 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020012324 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
12325 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
12326 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
12327 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
12328 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
12329 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
12330 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
12331 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
12332 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012334track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020012335 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
12336 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
12337 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
12338 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012339 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
12340
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012341tls-tickets
12342 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
12343 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
12344 default value.
12345 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
12346 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012347
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012348verify [none|required]
12349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010012350 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012351 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
12352 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012353 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012354 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
12355 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
12356 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
12357 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
12358 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
12359 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
12360 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
12361 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012362
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012363verifyhost <hostname>
12364 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020012365 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
12366 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
12367 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
12368 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
12369 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
12370 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
12371 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
12372 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070012373
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012374weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012375 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
12376 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
12377 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020012378 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
12379 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
12380 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
12381 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
12382 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
12383 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012384
12385
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200123865.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
12387-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012388
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012389HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
12390using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
12391configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012392This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
12393can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
12394workload.
12395This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
12396resolution at run time.
12397Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
12398carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
12399
12400
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124015.3.1. Global overview
12402----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012403
12404As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
12405different steps of the process life:
12406
12407 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
12408 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
12409 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
12410
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012411 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
12412 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012413
12414A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
12415 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
12416 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
12417 resolution to know this new IP.
12418
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012419When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012420HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012421SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
12422from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
12423will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
12424will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020012425
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012426A few things important to notice:
12427 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
12428 first valid response.
12429
12430 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
12431 servers return an error.
12432
12433
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200124345.3.2. The resolvers section
12435----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012436
12437This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012438HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
12439contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012440
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012441When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
12442uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
12443is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
12444answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
12445
12446When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012447used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012448
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012449 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
12450 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
12451 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012452
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012453 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
12454 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012455
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012456 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
12457 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
12458 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012459
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012460For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
12461following scenarios are possible:
12462
12463 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
12464 ignored
12465
12466 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
12467 applied
12468
12469 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
12470 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
12471
12472 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
12473 retries the query with a new type
12474
12475 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
12476 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012477
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012478As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
12479a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012480<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012481
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012482
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012483resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012484 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012485
12486A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
12487
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012488accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012489 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012490 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020012491 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
12492 by RFC 6891)
12493
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020012494 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
12495
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012496nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
12497 DNS server description:
12498 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
12499 <ip> : IP address of the server
12500 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
12501
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012502parse-resolv-conf
12503 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
12504 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
12505 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
12506
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012507hold <status> <period>
12508 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
12509 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012510 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012511 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012512 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
12513 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12514 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
12515
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020012516 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012517
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012518resolution_pool_size <nb> (deprecated)
Baptiste Assmann201c07f2017-05-22 15:17:15 +020012519 Defines the number of resolutions available in the pool for this resolvers.
12520 If not defines, it defaults to 64. If your configuration requires more than
12521 <nb>, then HAProxy will return an error when parsing the configuration.
12522
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012523resolve_retries <nb>
12524 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
12525 giving up.
12526 Default value: 3
12527
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020012528 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
12529 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
12530 type.
12531
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012532timeout <event> <time>
12533 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
12534 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
12535 events available are:
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012536 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
12537 other time applied.
12538 Default value: 1s
12539 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
12540 have been received.
12541 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012542 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
12543 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
12544
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020012545 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012546
12547 resolvers mydns
12548 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
12549 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060012550 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012551 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020012552 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012553 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010012554 hold other 30s
12555 hold refused 30s
12556 hold nx 30s
12557 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012558 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020012559 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020012560
12561
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200125626. HTTP header manipulation
12563---------------------------
12564
12565In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
12566response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
12567request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
12568which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012569against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012570
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010012571If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
12572to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
12573but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
12574HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
12575stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
12576because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
12577a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
12578still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020012579
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012580This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
12581in section 4.2 :
12582
12583 - reqadd <string>
12584 - reqallow <search>
12585 - reqiallow <search>
12586 - reqdel <search>
12587 - reqidel <search>
12588 - reqdeny <search>
12589 - reqideny <search>
12590 - reqpass <search>
12591 - reqipass <search>
12592 - reqrep <search> <replace>
12593 - reqirep <search> <replace>
12594 - reqtarpit <search>
12595 - reqitarpit <search>
12596 - rspadd <string>
12597 - rspdel <search>
12598 - rspidel <search>
12599 - rspdeny <search>
12600 - rspideny <search>
12601 - rsprep <search> <replace>
12602 - rspirep <search> <replace>
12603
12604With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
12605is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
12606parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
12607prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
12608Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
12609
12610 \t for a tab
12611 \r for a carriage return (CR)
12612 \n for a new line (LF)
12613 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
12614 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
12615 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
12616 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
12617 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
12618
12619The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
12620portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
12621above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
12622regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
126239 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
12624is very common to users of the "sed" program.
12625
12626The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
12627after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
12628
12629Notes related to these keywords :
12630---------------------------------
12631 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
12632 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
12633 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
12634
12635 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
12636 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
12637 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
12638
12639 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
12640 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
12641 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
12642 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
12643 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
12644
12645 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
12646 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
12647 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
12648 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
12649 useless headers before adding new ones.
12650
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012651 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012652 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
12653
12654 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
12655 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
12656 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
12657
12658 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
12659 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012660 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012661
12662
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200126637. Using ACLs and fetching samples
12664----------------------------------
12665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012666HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012667client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
12668The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
12669these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
12670but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
12671data called patterns.
12672
12673
126747.1. ACL basics
12675---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012676
12677The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
12678content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
12679from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
12680simple :
12681
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012682 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012683 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012684 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
12685 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012687The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
12688adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012689
12690In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
12691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012692 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012693
12694This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
12695Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
12696and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012697an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
12698conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
12699as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
12700are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012701
12702ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
12703'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
12704which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
12705
12706There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
12707performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
12708
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012709The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
12710specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
12711this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012712methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
12713ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012714
12715Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
12716 - boolean
12717 - integer (signed or unsigned)
12718 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
12719 - string
12720 - data block
12721
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012722Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
12723converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
12724would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
12725The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
12726which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
12727
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012728Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
12729keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
12730fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
12731which are summarized in the table below :
12732
12733 +---------------------+-----------------+
12734 | Sample or converter | Default |
12735 | output type | matching method |
12736 +---------------------+-----------------+
12737 | boolean | bool |
12738 +---------------------+-----------------+
12739 | integer | int |
12740 +---------------------+-----------------+
12741 | ip | ip |
12742 +---------------------+-----------------+
12743 | string | str |
12744 +---------------------+-----------------+
12745 | binary | none, use "-m" |
12746 +---------------------+-----------------+
12747
12748Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
12749matching method, see below.
12750
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012751The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
12752 - boolean
12753 - integer or integer range
12754 - IP address / network
12755 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
12756 - regular expression
12757 - hex block
12758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012759The following ACL flags are currently supported :
12760
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012761 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
12762 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012763 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012764 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012765 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012766 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012767 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
12768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012769The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
12770read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
12771if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
12772lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
12773will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
12774beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
12775a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
12776lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
12777exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
12778
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010012779The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
12780parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
12781ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
12782a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
12783check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
12784
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010012785The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
12786socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
12787file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
12788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012789Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
12790loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
12791
12792 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
12793
12794In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
12795the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
12796case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
12797as well.
12798
12799The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
12800sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
12801do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
12802methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
12803is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012804obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012805followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
12806default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
12807that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
12808string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
12809
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010012810The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
12811By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
12812string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
12813resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
12814server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
12815waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
12816flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
12817function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
12818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012819There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
12820sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
12821be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012822
12823 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12824 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012825 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12826 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12827 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12828 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012829
12830 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12831 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012832 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012833
12834 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012835 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012836
12837 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012838 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012839
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012840 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012841 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12842
12843 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12844 binary or string samples.
12845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012846 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12847 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012849 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12850 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12851 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012853 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12854 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012856 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12857 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012859 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12860 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012862 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12863 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012864 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012866 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12867 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12868 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012869
12870For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12871request, it is possible to do :
12872
12873 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12874
12875In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12876buffer, one would use the following acl :
12877
12878 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12879
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012880On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12881possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12882
12883 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012885All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12886criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12887method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12888to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12889criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12890the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012892If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012893the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12894For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012896 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12897 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12898 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12899 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012900
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012901
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012902The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12903types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12904combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12905brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12906default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012908 +-------------------------------------------------+
12909 | Input sample type |
12910 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012911 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012912 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12913 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12914 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012915 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012916 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012917 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012918 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012919 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012920 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012921 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012923 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012925 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012926 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012927 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012928 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012929 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012931 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012932 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012933 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012934 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012935 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012936 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12937 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12938 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012939
12940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129417.1.1. Matching booleans
12942------------------------
12943
12944In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12945Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12946When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12947that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12948
12949Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12950return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12951"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12952
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129547.1.2. Matching integers
12955------------------------
12956
12957Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12958enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12959to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12960
12961Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12962matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12963lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012964
12965For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12966unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12967representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12968
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012969As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12970two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12971instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12972ranges and operators.
12973
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012974For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012975operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12976Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12977of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012978
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012979Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012980
12981 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12982 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12983 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12984 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12985 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12986
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012987For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012988
12989 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12990
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012991This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12992
12993 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12994
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200129967.1.3. Matching strings
12997-----------------------
12998
12999String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
13000different forms :
13001
13002 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013003 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004
13005 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013006 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013007
13008 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
13009 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13010
13011 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
13012 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
13013
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010013014 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013015 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
13016 matches.
13017
13018 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
13019 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
13020 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013021
13022String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
13023exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
13024characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
13025string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
13026to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013027before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013028
13029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130307.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
13031---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013032
13033Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
13034they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
13035possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
13036passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
13037the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013038the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
13039match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013040
13041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200130427.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
13043-------------------------------------
13044
13045It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
13046not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
13047a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
13048to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
13049digits may be used upper or lower case.
13050
13051Example :
13052 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
13053 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
13054
13055
130567.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
13057---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013058
13059IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
13060netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
13061within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013062host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013063difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
13064at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
13065does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
13066parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013067
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020013068The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
13069abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
13070
13071 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13072 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
13073 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13074 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
13075 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
13076 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
13077 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
13078 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
13079
13080Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
13081192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
13082
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013083IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
13084Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
13085trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
13086IPv6 patterns.
13087
13088HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
13089following situations :
13090 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
13091 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
13092 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
13093 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
13094 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
13095 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
13096 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
13097 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
13098 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
13099 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
13100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013101
131027.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
13103----------------------------------
13104
13105Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
13106combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
13107
13108 - AND (implicit)
13109 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
13110 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013111
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013114 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
13117indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020013118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013119For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
13120"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
13121requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
13122is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
13123
13124 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013125 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
13126 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
13127 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013128
13129To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
13130and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
13131
13132 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
13133 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
13134 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
13135 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
13136
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013137 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013138 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
13139 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
13140 use_backend www if host_www
13141
13142It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
13143expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
13144be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
13145the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
13146
13147 The following rule :
13148
13149 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013150 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013151
13152 Can also be written that way :
13153
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013154 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013155
13156It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
13157to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
13158simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
13159sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
13160good use is the following :
13161
13162 With named ACLs :
13163
13164 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
13165 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
13166 monitor fail if site_dead
13167
13168 With anonymous ACLs :
13169
13170 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
13171
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030013172See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
13173keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174
13175
131767.3. Fetching samples
13177---------------------
13178
13179Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
13180against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
13181sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
13182ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
13183of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
13184available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
13185
13186This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
13187Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
13188compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
13189deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
13190
13191The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
13192matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
13193method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
13194indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
13195
13196As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
13197when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
13198mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
13199the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
13200ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
13201
13202Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
13203multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
13204when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013205incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
13206are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013207is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
13208all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
13209
13210Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
13211 - name
13212 - name(arg1)
13213 - name(arg1,arg2)
13214
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013215
132167.3.1. Converters
13217-----------------
13218
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013219Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
13220of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
13221is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
13222was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013223has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010013224unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
13225
13226These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
13227sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
13228the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013229support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013230
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013231A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
13232support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
13233supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
13234(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
13235bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
13236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013237The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013238
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001323951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
13240 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13241 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13242 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
13243 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13244 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13245
13246 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013247 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
13248 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000013249 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
13250 frontend http-in
13251 bind *:8081
13252 default_backend servers
13253 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13254 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13255
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013256add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013257 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013258 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013259 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
13260 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013261 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013262 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13263 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13264 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13265 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013266 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013267 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013268
13269and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013270 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013271 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013272 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13273 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013274 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013275 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13276 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13277 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13278 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013279 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013280 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013281
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020013282b64dec
13283 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
13284 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
13285
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013286base64
13287 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013288 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020013289 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
13290
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013291bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013292 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013293 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013294 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013295 presence of a flag).
13296
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013297bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
13298 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
13299 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013300 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010013301
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010013302concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
13303 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
13304 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
13305 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
13306 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
13307 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
13308 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
13309 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
13310 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
13311 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
13312 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
13313 other variables, such as colon-delimited varlues. Note that due to the config
13314 parser, it is not possible to use a comma nor a closing parenthesis as
13315 delimitors.
13316
13317 Example:
13318 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
13319 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
13320 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
13321 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
13322
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013323cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013324 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
13325 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013326
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013327crc32([<avalanche>])
13328 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
13329 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13330 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13331 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13332 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13333 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
13334 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
13335 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
13336 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
13337 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013338 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
13339
13340crc32c([<avalanche>])
13341 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
13342 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13343 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13344 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
13345 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
13346 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
13347 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
13348 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013349
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010013350da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013351 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
13352 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
13353 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
13354 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013355 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013356 configuration language.
13357
13358 Example:
13359 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020013360 bind *:8881
13361 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000013362 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020013363
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020013364debug
13365 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
13366 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
13367 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
13368
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013369div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013370 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13371 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013372 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013373 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13374 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013375 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013376 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13377 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13378 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13379 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013380 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013381 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013382
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013383djb2([<avalanche>])
13384 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
13385 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13386 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13387 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13388 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13389 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13390 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013391 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
13392 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013393
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013394even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013395 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013396 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
13397
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013398field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13399 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
13400 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
13401 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
13402 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
13403 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
13404 fields.
13405
13406 Example :
13407 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
13408 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13409 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
13410 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
13411 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010013412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013413hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013414 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013415 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013416 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013417 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010013418
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020013419hex2i
13420 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
13421 integer. If the input value can not be converted, then zero is returned.
13422
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013423http_date([<offset>])
13424 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13425 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
13426 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
13427 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
13428 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
13429 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013430
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013431in_table(<table>)
13432 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13433 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
13434 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013435 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013436 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
13437
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013438ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
13439 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013440 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010013441 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
13442 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
13443 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
13444 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
13445 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013446
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013447json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013448 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013449 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013450 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013451 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
13452 of errors:
13453 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
13454 bytes, ...)
13455 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
13456 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
13457
13458 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
13459 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
13460 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
13461 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
13462 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
13463 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013464 - "ascii" : never fails;
13465 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
13466 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013467 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013468 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013469 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
13470 characters corresponding to the other errors.
13471
13472 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013473 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013474
13475 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013476 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020013477 capture request header user-agent len 150
13478 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020013479
13480 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
13481 GET / HTTP/1.0
13482 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
13483
13484 Output log:
13485 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
13486
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013487language(<value>[,<default>])
13488 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
13489 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
13490 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
13491 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
13492 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
13493 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
13494 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
13495 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
13496 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013497 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013498 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
13499 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013500
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013501 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013502
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013503 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
13504 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013505
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013506 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
13507 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
13508 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
13509 use_backend spanish if es
13510 use_backend french if fr
13511 use_backend english if en
13512 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020013513
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010013514length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010013515 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
13516 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13517 type. The result is of type integer.
13518
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013519lower
13520 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
13521 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13522 type. The result is of type string.
13523
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013524ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
13525 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13526 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
13527 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13528 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13529 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13530 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
13531
13532 Example :
13533
13534 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013535 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013536 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13537
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013538map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13539map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13540map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
13541 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
13542 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
13543 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
13544 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
13545 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
13546 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
13547 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
13548 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013549
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013550 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
13551 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
13552 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013553
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013554 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013555 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013556
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013557 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
13558 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13559 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
13560 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020013561 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
13562 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013563 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
13564 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13565 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
13566 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13567 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
13568 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13569 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
13570 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080013571 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
13572 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13573 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013574 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13575 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
13576 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
13577 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
13578 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013579
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010013580 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
13581 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
13582 the corresponding match text.
13583
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013584 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
13585 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
13586 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
13587 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
13588 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013589
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020013590 Example :
13591
13592 # this is a comment and is ignored
13593 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
13594 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
13595 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
13596 | | | `---------- value
13597 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
13598 | `---------------------------- key
13599 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
13600
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013601mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013602 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
13603 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013604 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013605 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013606 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013607 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13608 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13609 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13610 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013612 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013613
13614mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013615 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020013616 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
13617 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013618 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013619 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013620 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013621 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13622 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13623 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13624 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013625 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013626 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013627
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010013628nbsrv
13629 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
13630 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
13631 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
13632 map lookup.
13633
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013634neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013635 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
13636 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
13637 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
13638 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013639
13640not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013641 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013642 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013643 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013644 absence of a flag).
13645
13646odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013647 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013648 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
13649
13650or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013651 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013652 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013653 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
13654 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013655 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013656 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13657 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
13658 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
13659 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013660 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013661 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013662
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010013663regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013664 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
13665 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
13666 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
13667 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
13668 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
13669 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
13670 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
13671 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
13672 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
13673 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010013674 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
13675 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
13676 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
13677 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010013678
13679 Example :
13680
13681 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
13682 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
13683 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
13684 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
13685
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013686capture-req(<id>)
13687 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
13688 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13689
13690 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013691 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13692 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013693
13694capture-res(<id>)
13695 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
13696 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
13697
13698 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020013699 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
13700 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020013701
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013702sdbm([<avalanche>])
13703 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
13704 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13705 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13706 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13707 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13708 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13709 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013710 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
13711 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013712
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013713set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013714 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
13715 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
13716 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013717 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013718 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13719 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013720 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013721 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13722 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013723 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013724 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013725
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020013726sha1
13727 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA1 digest. The result is a binary
13728 sample with length of 20 bytes.
13729
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020013730strcmp(<var>)
13731 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
13732 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
13733 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
13734 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
13735 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
13736 shorter).
13737
13738 Example :
13739
13740 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
13741 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
13742 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
13743
13744
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013745sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013746 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
13747 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013748 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013749 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
13750 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013751 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013752 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13753 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013754 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013755 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13756 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013757 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013758 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013759
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013760table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
13761 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13762 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13763 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
13764 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13765 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13766 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
13767
13768
13769table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
13770 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13771 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13772 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
13773 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
13774 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
13775 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
13776
13777table_conn_cnt(<table>)
13778 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13779 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013780 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013781 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
13782 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13783
13784table_conn_cur(<table>)
13785 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13786 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13787 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13788 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13789 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
13790
13791table_conn_rate(<table>)
13792 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13793 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13794 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
13795 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13796 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
13797
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013798table_gpt0(<table>)
13799 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13800 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
13801 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13802 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
13803 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
13804
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013805table_gpc0(<table>)
13806 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13807 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13808 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
13809 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13810 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
13811
13812table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
13813 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13814 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13815 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
13816 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13817 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
13818 sample fetch keyword.
13819
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013820table_gpc1(<table>)
13821 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13822 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13823 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
13824 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
13825 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
13826
13827table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
13828 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13829 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13830 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
13831 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
13832 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
13833 sample fetch keyword.
13834
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013835table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
13836 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13837 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013838 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013839 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
13840 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13841
13842table_http_err_rate(<table>)
13843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13845 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
13846 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
13847 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
13848 keyword.
13849
13850table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
13851 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13852 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013853 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013854 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
13855 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
13856
13857table_http_req_rate(<table>)
13858 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13859 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13860 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
13861 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
13862 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
13863 keyword.
13864
13865table_kbytes_in(<table>)
13866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013869 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13870 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13871 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
13872 keyword.
13873
13874table_kbytes_out(<table>)
13875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013878 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
13879 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
13880 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
13881 keyword.
13882
13883table_server_id(<table>)
13884 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13885 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13886 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
13887 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
13888 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
13889 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
13890
13891table_sess_cnt(<table>)
13892 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13893 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013894 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020013895 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
13896 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13897 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
13898 keyword.
13899
13900table_sess_rate(<table>)
13901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
13904 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
13905 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
13906 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
13907 keyword.
13908
13909table_trackers(<table>)
13910 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13911 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13912 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13913 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13914 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13915 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13916 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13917 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13918 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13919 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13920
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013921upper
13922 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13923 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13924 type. The result is of type string.
13925
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013926url_dec
13927 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13928 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13929
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013930unset-var(<var name>)
13931 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13932 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13933 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13934 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13935 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13936 response),
13937 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13938 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13939 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13940 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13941
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013942utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13943 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13944 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13945 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13946 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13947 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13948 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13949
13950 Example :
13951
13952 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013953 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013954 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13955
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020013956word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
13957 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
13958 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
13959 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13960 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
13961 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
13962
13963 Example :
13964 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
13965 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
13966 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
13967 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
13968 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013969
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013970wt6([<avalanche>])
13971 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13972 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13973 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13974 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13975 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13976 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13977 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010013978 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
13979 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013980
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013981xor(<value>)
13982 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013983 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013984 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013985 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13988 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013989 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013990 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13991 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013992 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013993 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013994
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013995xxh32([<seed>])
13996 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13997 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13998 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13999 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14000 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14001 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14002 as cryptographically secure.
14003
14004xxh64([<seed>])
14005 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
14006 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
14007 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
14008 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
14009 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
14010 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
14011 as cryptographically secure.
14012
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014013
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140147.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014015--------------------------------------------
14016
14017A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
14018not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
14019"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
14020The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
14021
14022always_false : boolean
14023 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14024 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14025
14026always_true : boolean
14027 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
14028 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
14029
14030avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014031 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014032 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
14033 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
14034 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
14035 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
14036 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
14037 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
14038 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
14039 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
14040 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
14041 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
14042 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
14043 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
14044 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010014045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014047 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
14048 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
14049 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
14050 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014051 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
14052
14053be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
14054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14055 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
14056 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
14057 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
14058 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014059 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
14060 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040014061
14062 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
14063 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
14064 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
14067 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14068 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14069 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014070 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014071 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
14072 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014073
14074 Example :
14075 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
14076 backend dynamic
14077 mode http
14078 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
14079 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014080
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014081bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014082 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
14083 of the string.
14084
14085bool(<bool>) : bool
14086 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
14087 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
14088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014089connslots([<backend>]) : integer
14090 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014091 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014092 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
14093 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050014094
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014095 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014096 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014097 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
14098
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014099 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
14100 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014101
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014102 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014103 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014105 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014106 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014107 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014108 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014109
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014110 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
14111 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014112 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020014113 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080014114
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014115cpu_calls : integer
14116 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
14117 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
14118 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
14119 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
14120 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
14121 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
14122
14123cpu_ns_avg : integer
14124 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14125 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14126 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14127 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14128 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14129 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14130 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
14131 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
14132 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
14133 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
14134 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14135
14136cpu_ns_tot : integer
14137 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
14138 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
14139 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
14140 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
14141 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
14142 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
14143 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
14144 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
14145 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
14146 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
14147 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
14148 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
14149 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
14150
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014151date([<offset>]) : integer
14152 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
14153 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
14154 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
14155 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020014156 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
14157
14158 Example :
14159
14160 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
14161 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020014162
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010014163date_us : integer
14164 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
14165 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
14166 from the same timeval structure.
14167
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020014168distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
14169 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
14170 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
14171 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
14172 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
14173 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
14174 list of supported tokens.
14175
14176distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
14177 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
14178 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
14179 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
14180 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
14181 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
14182 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
14183 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
14184 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
14185 supported tokens.
14186
14187 Example :
14188 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
14189 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
14190 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
14191 # send large files to the big farm
14192 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
14193
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020014194env(<name>) : string
14195 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
14196 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
14197 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
14198 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
14199 certain way.
14200
14201 Examples :
14202 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
14203 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
14204
14205 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
14206 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
14207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014208fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
14209 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014210 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
14211 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014212 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
14213 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014214 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
14216 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020014217
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020014218fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14219 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
14220 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
14221 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
14222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014223fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
14224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14225 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
14226 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
14227 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
14228 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
14229 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
14230 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
14231 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014232
14233 Example :
14234 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
14235 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
14236 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
14237 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
14238 frontend mail
14239 bind :25
14240 mode tcp
14241 maxconn 100
14242 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
14243 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
14244 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
14245 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014246
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010014247hostname : string
14248 Returns the system hostname.
14249
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014250int(<integer>) : signed integer
14251 Returns a signed integer.
14252
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014253ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
14254 Returns an ipv4.
14255
14256ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
14257 Returns an ipv6.
14258
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010014259lat_ns_avg : integer
14260 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14261 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14262 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14263 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14264 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14265 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14266 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14267 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14268 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14269 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14270 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14271 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14272 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex.
14273 Note: this value is exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
14274
14275lat_ns_tot : integer
14276 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
14277 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
14278 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
14279 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
14280 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
14281 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
14282 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
14283 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
14284 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
14285 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, or to look for
14286 other heavy requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"),
14287 whose processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers
14288 could be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
14289 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
14290 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
14291 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
14292 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
14293 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
14294 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
14295
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014296meth(<method>) : method
14297 Returns a method.
14298
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014299nbproc : integer
14300 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
14301 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
14302 and debugging purposes.
14303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014304nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
14305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
14306 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
14307 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014308 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
14309 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
14310 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010014311
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040014312prio_class : integer
14313 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
14314 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
14315 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
14316
14317prio_offset : integer
14318 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
14319 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
14320 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
14321 set-priority-offset".
14322
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014323proc : integer
14324 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
14325 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
14326 debugging purposes.
14327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014329 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
14330 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
14331 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014332 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
14333 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
14334 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
14335 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
14336 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
14337
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010014338rand([<range>]) : integer
14339 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
14340 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
14341 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
14342 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
14343 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
14344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014345srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14346 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14347 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
14348 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
14349 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
14350 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040014351 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
14352 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
14353
14354srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14355 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
14356 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
14357 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14358 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
14359 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
14360 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
14361 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
14362
14363 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
14364 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365
14366srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
14367 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
14368 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
14369 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014370 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014371 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
14372 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
14373 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
14374
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020014375srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14376 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
14377 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
14378 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
14379 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
14380 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
14381 fetch methods.
14382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014383srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
14384 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
14385 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014386 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014387 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
14388 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014389 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014390 overloading servers).
14391
14392 Example :
14393 # Redirect to a separate back
14394 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
14395 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
14396 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
14397
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010014398stopping : boolean
14399 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
14400 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
14401 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
14402
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020014403str(<string>) : string
14404 Returns a string.
14405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014406table_avl([<table>]) : integer
14407 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
14408 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
14409
14410table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14411 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
14412 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
14413 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
14414
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010014415thread : integer
14416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
14417 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
14418 and debugging purposes.
14419
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014420var(<var-name>) : undefined
14421 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014422 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
14423 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014424 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014425 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14426 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014427 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014428 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
14429 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014430 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014431 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014432
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144337.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434----------------------------------
14435
14436The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
14437closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
14438methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
14439sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
14440TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014441the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
14442counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020014443"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
14444used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
14445can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
14446Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
14447table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
14448tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
14449currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014450
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010014451bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010014452 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14453 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14454 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
14455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456be_id : integer
14457 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
14458 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14459
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014460be_name : string
14461 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
14462 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
14463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014464dst : ip
14465 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
14466 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
14467 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
14468 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014469 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
14470 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
14471 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
14472 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
14473 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
14474 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014475
14476dst_conn : integer
14477 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
14478 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
14479 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
14480 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
14481 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
14482 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
14483 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
14484 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014485
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014486dst_is_local : boolean
14487 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
14488 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
14489 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
14490 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014491 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014492 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
14493 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
14494 it only once per connection.
14495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014496dst_port : integer
14497 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
14498 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
14499 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
14500 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
14501 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
14502 an HTTP header.
14503
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020014504fc_http_major : integer
14505 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
14506 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
14507 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
14508
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010014509fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
14510 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
14511 header.
14512
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020014513fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
14514 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
14515 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
14516 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
14517 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14518 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14519 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14520
14521fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
14522 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
14523 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
14524 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
14525 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
14526 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
14527 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14528
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070014529fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
14530 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14531 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14532 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14533 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14534
14535fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
14536 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
14537 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
14538 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
14539 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14540
14541fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
14542 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
14543 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14544 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14545 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14546
14547fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
14548 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
14549 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14550 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14551 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14552
14553fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
14554 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
14555 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14556 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14557 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14558
14559fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
14560 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
14561 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
14562 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
14563 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
14564
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020014565fe_defbe : string
14566 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
14567 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
14568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014569fe_id : integer
14570 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010014571 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014572 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14573
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010014574fe_name : string
14575 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
14576 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
14577 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
14578
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014579sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014580sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14581sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14582sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014583 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
14584 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14585 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
14586
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014587sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014588sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14589sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14590sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014591 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
14592 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
14593 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
14594
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014595sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014596sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14597sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14598sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014599 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14600 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014601 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14602 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14603 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014604
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014605 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014606 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14607 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014608 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14609 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
14610 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014611 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14612 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14613
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014614sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14615sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14616sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14617sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14618 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
14619 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
14620 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
14621 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
14622 when a first ACL was verified.
14623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014624sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014625sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14626sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14627sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014628 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014629 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
14630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014631sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014632sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14633sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
14634sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014635 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14636 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
14637 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
14638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014639sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014640sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14641sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14642sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014643 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
14644 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
14645 See also src_conn_rate.
14646
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014647sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014648sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14649sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14650sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014651 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014652 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014653
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014654sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14655sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14656sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14657sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14658 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14659 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14660
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014661sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14662sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14663sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14664sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14665 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14666 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
14667
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014668sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014669sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14670sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
14671sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014672 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
14673 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14674 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014675 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14676 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14677 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014678
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014679sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14680sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14681sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14682sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14683 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14684 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
14685 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14686 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14687 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14688 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14689
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014690sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014691sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14692sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14693sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014694 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014695 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
14696 See also src_http_err_cnt.
14697
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014698sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014699sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14700sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14701sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014702 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
14703 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14704 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
14705 src_http_err_rate.
14706
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014707sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014708sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14709sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14710sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014711 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014712 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14713 src_http_req_cnt.
14714
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014715sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014716sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14717sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14718sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014719 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
14720 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
14721 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
14722 src_http_req_rate.
14723
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014724sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014725sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14726sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14727sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014728 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014729 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14730 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14731 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14732 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014733
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014734 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014735 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
14736 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014737 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14738
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014739sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
14740sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14741sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14742sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14743 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
14744 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
14745 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
14746 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
14747 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
14748
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014749sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014750sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14751sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
14752sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014753 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
14754 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14755 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014756
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014757sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014758sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14759sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
14760sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014761 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
14762 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
14763 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014764
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014765sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014766sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14767sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
14768sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014769 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014770 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
14771 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
14772 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014773 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014774 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
14775
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014776sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014777sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14778sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
14779sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014780 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
14781 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
14782 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
14783 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
14784 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014785 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014786
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014787sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014788sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14789sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
14790sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020014791 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
14792 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
14793 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
14794
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020014795sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020014796sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14797sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
14798sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014799 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
14800 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014801 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014802 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
14803 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
14805 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
14806 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010014807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014808so_id : integer
14809 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
14810 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
14811 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014815 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
14816 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
14817 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014818 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
14819 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
14820 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010014821 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
14822 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
14823 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
14824 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
14825 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
14826 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
14827 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014828
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010014829 Example:
14830 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
14831 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
14832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014833src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
14834 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
14835 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
14836 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014837 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014839src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
14840 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
14841 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014842 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014843 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014845src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14846 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14847 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14848 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14849 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14850 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14851 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014852
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014853 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014854 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
14855 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
14856 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
14857 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014858 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020014859 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
14860 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
14861
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014862src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14863 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14864 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14865 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
14866 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
14867 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
14868 was verified.
14869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014870src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014871 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014872 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014873 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014874 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014876src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014877 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014878 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14879 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014880 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014882src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
14883 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
14884 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14885 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014886 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014889 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014891 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014892 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014893
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014894src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14895 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
14896 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14897 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14898 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
14899
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014900src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
14901 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
14902 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
14903 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
14904 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
14905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014906src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014907 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014908 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014909 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14910 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014911 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
14912 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14913 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020014914
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014915src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
14916 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
14917 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
14918 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
14919 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
14920 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
14921 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
14922 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
14923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014924src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014925 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014926 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014927 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014928 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014931src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
14932 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
14933 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14934 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
14935 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014936 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014939 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014940 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14941 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014942 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014944src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
14945 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
14946 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
14947 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014948 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020014949 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014951src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
14952 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14953 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14954 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014955 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14957 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014958
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014959 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014960 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010014961 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020014962 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014963
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014964src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
14965 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
14966 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
14967 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
14968 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
14969 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
14970 connection when a first ACL was verified.
14971
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014972src_is_local : boolean
14973 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
14974 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
14975 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
14976 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014977 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020014978 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
14979 once per connection.
14980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014981src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014982 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
14983 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
14984 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
14985 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
14986 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020014987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014988src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020014989 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
14990 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
14991 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
14992 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
14993 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020014994
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014995src_port : integer
14996 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
14997 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
14998 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
14999 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015000
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015001src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015002 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015003 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
15004 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
15005 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015006 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015008src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
15009 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
15010 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
15011 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
15012 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020015013 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015015src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
15016 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
15017 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
15018 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
15019 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
15020 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
15021 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
15022 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
15023 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015024
15025 Example :
15026 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
15027 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
15028 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
15029 listen ssh
15030 bind :22
15031 mode tcp
15032 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020015033 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015034 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020015035 server local 127.0.0.1:22
15036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015037srv_id : integer
15038 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
15039 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
15040 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020015041
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200150427.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015043----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020015044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015045The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
15046closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
15047when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
15048usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015049future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015050
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001505151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
15052 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15053 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15054 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
15055 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15056 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15057
15058 Example :
15059 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
15060 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
15061 # the request.
15062 frontend http-in
15063 bind *:8081
15064 default_backend servers
15065 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15066 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15067
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015068ssl_bc : boolean
15069 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15070 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
15071 other a server with the "ssl" option.
15072
15073ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
15074 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
15075 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15076
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015077ssl_bc_alpn : string
15078 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
15079 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
15080 The result is a string containing the protocol name negociated with the
15081 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15082 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15083 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
15084 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
15085 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15086 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn".
15087
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015088ssl_bc_cipher : string
15089 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
15090 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15091
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010015092ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
15093 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15094 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
15095 session or a TLS ticket.
15096
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010015097ssl_bc_npn : string
15098 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
15099 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
15100 protocol name negociated with the server . The SSL library must have been
15101 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
15102 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
15103 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
15104 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
15105 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
15106
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015107ssl_bc_protocol : string
15108 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
15109 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15110
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015111ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015112 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015113 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15114 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015115
15116ssl_bc_session_id : binary
15117 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
15118 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
15119 if session was reused or not.
15120
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015121ssl_bc_session_key : binary
15122 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
15123 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15124 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15125 BoringSSL.
15126
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020015127ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
15128 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
15129 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015131ssl_c_ca_err : integer
15132 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15133 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
15134 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
15135 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
15136 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020015137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015138ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
15139 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15140 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
15141 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
15142 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015143
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015144ssl_c_der : binary
15145 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
15146 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15147 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015149ssl_c_err : integer
15150 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15151 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
15152 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
15153 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
15154 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015156ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15157 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15158 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15159 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15160 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15161 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15162 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15163 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15164 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015166ssl_c_key_alg : string
15167 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15168 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15169 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015171ssl_c_notafter : string
15172 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
15173 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15174 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015176ssl_c_notbefore : string
15177 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
15178 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15179 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015181ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15182 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15183 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15184 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15185 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15186 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15187 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15188 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15189 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010015190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015191ssl_c_serial : binary
15192 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
15193 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15194 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015195
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015196ssl_c_sha1 : binary
15197 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
15198 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
15199 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015200 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
15201 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
15202
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030015203 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020015204 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015205
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015206ssl_c_sig_alg : string
15207 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15208 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15209 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015210
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015211ssl_c_used : boolean
15212 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
15213 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015215ssl_c_verify : integer
15216 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
15217 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
15218 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
15219 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015221ssl_c_version : integer
15222 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
15223 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015224
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010015225ssl_f_der : binary
15226 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
15227 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15228 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
15229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15231 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15232 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
15233 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15234 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015235 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015236 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15237 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15238 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240ssl_f_key_alg : string
15241 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
15242 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
15243 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015245ssl_f_notafter : string
15246 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15247 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15248 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250ssl_f_notbefore : string
15251 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
15252 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
15253 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015255ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
15256 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
15257 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
15258 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
15259 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
15260 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
15261 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
15262 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
15263 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020015264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015265ssl_f_serial : binary
15266 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15267 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
15268 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020015269
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020015270ssl_f_sha1 : binary
15271 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
15272 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
15273 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
15274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015275ssl_f_sig_alg : string
15276 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
15277 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
15278 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020015279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280ssl_f_version : integer
15281 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
15282 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15283
15284ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015285 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
15286 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
15287 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
15288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015289 Example :
15290 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
15291 listen http-https
15292 bind :80
15293 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
15294 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
15295
15296ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
15297 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
15298 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
15299
15300ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015301 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
15303 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
15304 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
15305 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
15306 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
15307 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
15308 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
15309 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
15310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015311ssl_fc_cipher : string
15312 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
15313 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015314
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015315ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
15316 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
15317 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015318 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015319
15320ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
15321 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
15322 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015323 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015324
15325ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
15326 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
15327 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
15328 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015329 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020015330 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015331
15332ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
15333 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
15334 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010015335 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010015336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015337ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015338 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
15339 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010015340 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
15341 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
15342 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
15343 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020015344
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020015345ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
15346 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
15347 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
15348 wait until the handshake happened.
15349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015350ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
15351 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020015352 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
15353 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
15354 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15355 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015356
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020015357ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015358 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010015359 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
15360 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020015361
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015362ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015363 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015364 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
15365 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
15366 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
15367 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
15368 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
15369 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
15370 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020015371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015372ssl_fc_protocol : string
15373 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
15374 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015375
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015376ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015377 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020015378 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
15379 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040015380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015381ssl_fc_session_id : binary
15382 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
15383 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
15384 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
15385 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020015386
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040015387ssl_fc_session_key : binary
15388 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
15389 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
15390 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
15391 BoringSSL.
15392
15393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015394ssl_fc_sni : string
15395 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
15396 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
15397 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
15398 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
15399 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
15400
15401 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
15402 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
15403 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020015404 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
15405 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015407 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015408 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
15409 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020015410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015411ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
15412 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
15413 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015414
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200154167.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015417------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020015418
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015419Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
15420sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
15421only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
15422For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
15423be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
15424can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
15425sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
15426for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
15427content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015428
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015429payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015430 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015431 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
15432 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015434payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
15435 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015436 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015437 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015438
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020015439req.hdrs : string
15440 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
15441 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
15442 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
15443 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
15444
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020015445req.hdrs_bin : binary
15446 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
15447 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
15448 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
15449 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
15450 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
15451 names and values (length of 0 for both).
15452
15453 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
15454
15455 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
15456 str: <int:length><bytes>
15457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015458req.len : integer
15459req_len : integer (deprecated)
15460 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15461 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15462 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15463 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15464 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15465 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15466 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
15467 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015468
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015469req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15470 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015471 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15472 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15473 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15474 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015476 ACL alternatives :
15477 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015478
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15480 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15481 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15482 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
15483 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015484
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015485 ACL alternatives :
15486 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015489
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015490req.proto_http : boolean
15491req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
15492 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
15493 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
15494 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
15495 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
15496 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
15497 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
15498 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015500 Example:
15501 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
15502 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15503 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020015504 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
15507rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15508 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
15509 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
15510 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
15511 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
15512 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
15513 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
15514 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015516 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
15517 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
15518 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
15519 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
15520 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
15521 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015522
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015523 ACL derivatives :
15524 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015525
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015526 Example :
15527 listen tse-farm
15528 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
15529 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
15530 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15531 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
15532 # apply RDP cookie persistence
15533 persist rdp-cookie
15534 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
15535 # This is only useful makes sense if
15536 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
15537 stick-table type string size 204800
15538 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
15539 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
15540 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015542 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
15543 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015545req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
15546rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
15547 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
15548 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
15549 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
15550 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015552 ACL derivatives :
15553 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015554
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015555req.ssl_alpn : string
15556 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
15557 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
15558 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
15559 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
15560 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
15561 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015562 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015563
15564 Examples :
15565 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15566 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15567 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020015568 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110015569 default_backend bk_default
15570
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015571req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
15572 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
15573 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015574 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
15575 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
15576 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
15577 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
15578 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020015579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015580req.ssl_hello_type : integer
15581req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15582 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15583 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
15584 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15585 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15586 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
15587 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15588 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015590req.ssl_sni : string
15591req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
15592 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
15593 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
15594 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
15595 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15596 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15597 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
15598 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
15599 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
15600 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
15601 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
15602 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
15603 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015605 ACL derivatives :
15606 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015608 Examples :
15609 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
15610 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
15611 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
15612 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
15613 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020015614
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053015615req.ssl_st_ext : integer
15616 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
15617 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
15618 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
15619 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
15620 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
15621 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
15622 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
15623 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
15624 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
15625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015626req.ssl_ver : integer
15627req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
15628 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
15629 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
15630 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
15631 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
15632 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
15633 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
15634 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015635 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015636 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015637
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015638 ACL derivatives :
15639 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015640
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020015641res.len : integer
15642 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
15643 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
15644 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
15645 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
15646 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
15647 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
15648 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
15649 content inspection.
15650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
15652 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020015653 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
15654 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
15655 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
15656 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015658res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
15659 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
15660 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
15661 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
15662 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015664 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015665
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020015666res.ssl_hello_type : integer
15667rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
15668 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
15669 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
15670 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
15671 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
15672 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
15673 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
15674 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
15675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015676wait_end : boolean
15677 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
15678 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015679 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
15681 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015682 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015683 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
15684 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015686 Examples :
15687 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
15688 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
15689 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
15692 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15693 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
15694 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
15695 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
15696 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
15697 tcp-request content reject
15698
15699
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200157007.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701--------------------------------------
15702
15703It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
15704This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
15705data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
15706its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
15707HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
15708content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
15709to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
15710more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
15711response are indexed.
15712
15713base : string
15714 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
15715 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
15716 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
15717 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
15718 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
15719 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
15720 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
15721 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
15722
15723 ACL derivatives :
15724 base : exact string match
15725 base_beg : prefix match
15726 base_dir : subdir match
15727 base_dom : domain match
15728 base_end : suffix match
15729 base_len : length match
15730 base_reg : regex match
15731 base_sub : substring match
15732
15733base32 : integer
15734 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
15735 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
15736 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015737 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
15738 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
15739 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015740
15741base32+src : binary
15742 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
15743 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
15744 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
15745 per-URL counters.
15746
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015747capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
15748 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
15749 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15750 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
15751
15752capture.req.method : string
15753 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
15754 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
15755 because it's allocated.
15756
15757capture.req.uri : string
15758 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
15759 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
15760 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
15761 allocated.
15762
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015763capture.req.ver : string
15764 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15765 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
15766 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
15767
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010015768capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
15769 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
15770 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
15771 The first entry is an index of 0.
15772 See also: "capture response header"
15773
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020015774capture.res.ver : string
15775 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
15776 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
15777 persistent flag.
15778
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015779req.body : binary
15780 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
15781 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15782 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
15783 the first chunk is analyzed.
15784
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020015785req.body_param([<name>) : string
15786 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
15787 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
15788 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
15789 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
15790 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
15791 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
15792 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
15793 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
15794 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
15795 given.
15796
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020015797req.body_len : integer
15798 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
15799 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
15800 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
15801 "option http-buffer-request".
15802
15803req.body_size : integer
15804 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
15805 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
15806 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
15807 that the request body has been buffered made available using
15808 "option http-buffer-request".
15809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810req.cook([<name>]) : string
15811cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15812 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15813 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
15814 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
15815 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
15816 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
15817 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
15818 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
15819 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
15820
15821 ACL derivatives :
15822 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
15823 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
15824 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
15825 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
15826 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
15827 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
15828 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
15829 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15832cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15833 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
15834 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015836req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
15837cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
15838 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15839 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
15840 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
15841 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020015842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015843cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
15844 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
15845 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
15846 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
15847 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020015848 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015849 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
15850 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
15851 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
15852 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015854hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15855 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
15856 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
15857 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
15858 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015859 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
15862 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15863 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15864 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15865 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15866 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15867 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
15868 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
15869 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15872 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15873 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
15874 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
15875 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015877req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
15878 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
15879 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
15880 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15881 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15882 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15883 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
15884 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
15885 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000015886 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015887 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015888 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015890 ACL derivatives :
15891 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
15892 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
15893 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
15894 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
15895 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
15896 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
15897 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
15898 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
15899
15900req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
15901hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
15902 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
15903 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
15904 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
15905 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
15906 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
15907 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
15908 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
15909 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
15910 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
15911
15912req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
15913hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
15914 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
15915 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
15916 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
15917 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
15918 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015919 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
15921 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
15922
15923req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
15924hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
15925 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
15926 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
15927 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
15928 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
15929 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
15930 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
15931 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
15932
15933http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
15934 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
15935 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
15936 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15937 basic auth is supported.
15938
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015939http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
15940 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
15941 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
15942 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
15943 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
15945 basic auth is supported.
15946
15947 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010015948 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
15949 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
15950 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
15951 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952
15953http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015954 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
15955 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015956 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
15957 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020015958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015959method : integer + string
15960 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
15961 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
15962 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
15963 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
15964 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
15965 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
15966 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015968 ACL derivatives :
15969 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015970
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015971 Example :
15972 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
15973 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
15974 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015976path : string
15977 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
15978 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
15979 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
15980 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
15981 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015982 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015983 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015985 ACL derivatives :
15986 path : exact string match
15987 path_beg : prefix match
15988 path_dir : subdir match
15989 path_dom : domain match
15990 path_end : suffix match
15991 path_len : length match
15992 path_reg : regex match
15993 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015994
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010015995query : string
15996 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
15997 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
15998 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
15999 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016000 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010016001 which stops before the question mark.
16002
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016003req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16004 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16005 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16006 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16007 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016009req.ver : string
16010req_ver : string (deprecated)
16011 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
16012 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
16013 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016015 ACL derivatives :
16016 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016018res.comp : boolean
16019 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
16020 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
16021 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016023res.comp_algo : string
16024 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
16025 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
16026 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016028res.cook([<name>]) : string
16029scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16030 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16031 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
16032 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016034 ACL derivatives :
16035 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020016036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016037res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16038scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16039 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
16040 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
16041 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016043res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
16044scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16045 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16046 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
16047 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016048
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016049res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16050 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16051 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16052 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16053 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16054 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
16055 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
16056 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
16057 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
16058 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016060res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16061 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16062 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16063 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
16064 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
16065 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016066
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
16068shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
16069 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
16070 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
16071 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
16072 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
16073 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
16074 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
16075 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
16076 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016078 ACL derivatives :
16079 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
16080 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
16081 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
16082 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
16083 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
16084 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
16085 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
16086 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
16087
16088res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
16089shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
16090 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
16091 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
16092 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
16093 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
16094 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016095
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016096res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
16097shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
16098 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
16099 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
16100 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
16101 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
16102 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
16103 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016104
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010016105res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
16106 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
16107 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
16108 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
16109 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
16110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016111res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
16112shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
16113 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
16114 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
16115 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
16116 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
16117 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
16118 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016119
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016120res.ver : string
16121resp_ver : string (deprecated)
16122 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
16123 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020016124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016125 ACL derivatives :
16126 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010016127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016128set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
16129 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
16130 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020016131 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
16135 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016136
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016137status : integer
16138 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
16139 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
16140 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016141
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020016142unique-id : string
16143 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
16144 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
16145 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
16146 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
16147 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
16148 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
16149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016150url : string
16151 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
16152 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
16153 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
16154 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
16155 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
16156 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
16157 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016159 ACL derivatives :
16160 url : exact string match
16161 url_beg : prefix match
16162 url_dir : subdir match
16163 url_dom : domain match
16164 url_end : suffix match
16165 url_len : length match
16166 url_reg : regex match
16167 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016168
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016169url_ip : ip
16170 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
16171 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
16172 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
16173 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
16174 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
16175 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16176 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016177
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016178url_port : integer
16179 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
16180 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
16181 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
16182 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016183
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016184urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
16185url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
16187 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016188 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
16189 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
16190 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
16191 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016192 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
16193 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020016194 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
16195 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016197 ACL derivatives :
16198 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
16199 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
16200 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
16201 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
16202 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
16203 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
16204 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
16205 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016206
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016208 Example :
16209 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
16210 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
16211 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
16212 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020016213
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016214urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016215 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
16216 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
16217 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020016218
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020016219url32 : integer
16220 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
16221 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
16222 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
16223 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
16224 is an unsigned integer.
16225
16226url32+src : binary
16227 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
16228 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
16229 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
16230
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010016231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200162327.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016233---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016234
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016235Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
16236every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020016237order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016238
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016239ACL name Equivalent to Usage
16240---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016241FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020016242HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016243HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
16244HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016245HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
16246HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
16247HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
16248HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
16249LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016250METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016251METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016252METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
16253METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
16254METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
16255METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020016256METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016257METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016258RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016259REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016260TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016261WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
16262---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010016263
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010016264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162658. Logging
16266----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016267
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016268One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
16269provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
16270very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
16271provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
16272state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016273to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016274headers.
16275
16276In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
16277about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
16278send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
16279
16280 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
16281 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
16282 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
16283 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
16284 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016285 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060016286 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016287
16288The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
16289allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
16290as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
16291while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
16292real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
16293delay.
16294
16295
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162968.1. Log levels
16297---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016298
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016299TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016300source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016301HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
16302in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
16303track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
16304syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
16305about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016306
16307
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163088.2. Log formats
16309----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016310
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016311HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090016312and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
16313slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
16314options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016315
16316 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
16317 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
16318 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
16319 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
16320 extents.
16321
16322 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
16323 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
16324 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
16325 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
16326 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
16327
16328 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
16329 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
16330 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
16331 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
16332 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
16333
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020016334 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
16335 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
16336 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
16337 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
16338
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016339 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
16340
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016341Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
16342specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
16343field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
16344servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
16345always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
16346identifier.
16347
16348Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
16349 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
16350 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
16351 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
16352 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
16353
16354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163558.2.1. Default log format
16356-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016357
16358This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
16359as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
16360format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
16361
16362 Example :
16363 listen www
16364 mode http
16365 log global
16366 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16367
16368 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
16369 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
16370 (www/HTTP)
16371
16372 Field Format Extract from the example above
16373 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
16374 2 'Connect from' Connect from
16375 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
16376 4 'to' to
16377 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
16378 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
16379
16380Detailed fields description :
16381 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
16382 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
16383 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
16384 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
16385 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16386 and processed the connection.
16387 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
16388
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016389In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
16390"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
16391connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
16392
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016393It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
16394will eventually disappear.
16395
16396
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163978.2.2. TCP log format
16398---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016399
16400The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
16401is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
16402information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
16403counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
16404emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
16405environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
16406the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
16407sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016408specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
16409not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
16410fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
16411marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016412
16413 Example :
16414 frontend fnt
16415 mode tcp
16416 option tcplog
16417 log global
16418 default_backend bck
16419
16420 backend bck
16421 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16422
16423 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
16424 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
16425 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
16426
16427 Field Format Extract from the example above
16428 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
16429 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
16430 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
16431 4 frontend_name fnt
16432 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
16433 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
16434 7 bytes_read* 212
16435 8 termination_state --
16436 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
16437 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16438
16439Detailed fields description :
16440 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016441 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16442 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16443 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016444 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016445 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016446 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016447
16448 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016449 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16450 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16451 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016452
16453 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
16454 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
16455 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016456 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
16457 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
16458 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
16459 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016460
16461 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16462 and processed the connection.
16463
16464 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16465 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16466 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
16467 applications.
16468
16469 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16470 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16471 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16472 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
16473 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
16474
16475 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16476 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
16477 See "Timers" below for more details.
16478
16479 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16480 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
16481 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
16482 "Timers" below for more details.
16483
16484 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016485 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016486 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
16487 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
16488 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
16489 details.
16490
16491 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
16492 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
16493 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
16494 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
16495 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
16496
16497 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16498 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16499 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
16500 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
16501 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
16502 for more details.
16503
16504 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016505 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016506 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
16507 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
16508 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016509 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510
16511 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16512 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16513 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16514 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16515 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16516 caused by a denial of service attack.
16517
16518 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16519 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16520 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16521 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16522 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16523 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16524 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16525 denial of service attack.
16526
16527 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16528 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16529 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16530 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16531 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16532 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16533 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16534 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
16535 be processed than on other servers.
16536
16537 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16538 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16539 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16540 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16541 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16542 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16543 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16544 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16545 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16546 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16547 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16548 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16549 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16550
16551 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16552 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16553 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16554 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16555 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16556 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016557 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016558 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16559
16560 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16561 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16562 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16563 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16564 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16565 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016566 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016567 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16568 occurs.
16569
16570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165718.2.3. HTTP log format
16572----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016573
16574The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
16575is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
16576the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
16577are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
16578emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
16579generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
16580"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
16581which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020016582frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
16583is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016584
16585Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
16586slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
16587with a star ('*') after the field name below.
16588
16589 Example :
16590 frontend http-in
16591 mode http
16592 option httplog
16593 log global
16594 default_backend bck
16595
16596 backend static
16597 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
16598
16599 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
16600 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
16601 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016602 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016603
16604 Field Format Extract from the example above
16605 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
16606 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016607 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016608 4 frontend_name http-in
16609 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016610 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016611 7 status_code 200
16612 8 bytes_read* 2750
16613 9 captured_request_cookie -
16614 10 captured_response_cookie -
16615 11 termination_state ----
16616 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
16617 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
16618 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
16619 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
16620 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016621
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016622Detailed fields description :
16623 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016624 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
16625 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
16626 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016627 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016628 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016629 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016630
16631 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010016632 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
16633 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
16634 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016635
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016636 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
16637 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016638
16639 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
16640 and processed the connection.
16641
16642 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
16643 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
16644 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
16645
16646 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
16647 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
16648 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
16649 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
16650 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
16651 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
16652
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016653 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
16654 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
16655 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
16656 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
16657 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
16658 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016659 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
16660 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016661
16662 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
16663 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016664 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016665
16666 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
16667 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016668 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
16669 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016670
16671 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
16672 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
16673 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
16674 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
16675 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016676 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
16677 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016678
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016679 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
16680 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
16681 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
16682 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
16683 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
16684 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
16685 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020016686 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016687
16688 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
16689 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
16690 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
16691
16692 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
16693 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
16694 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
16695 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
16696 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
16697 overflowing.
16698
16699 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
16700 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
16701 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
16702 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
16703 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
16704 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
16705 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
16706 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16707
16708 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
16709 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
16710 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
16711 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
16712 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
16713 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
16714 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
16715 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
16716
16717 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
16718 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
16719 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
16720 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
16721 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
16722 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
16723 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
16724
16725 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016726 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016727 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
16728 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
16729 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016730 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016731 system.
16732
16733 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
16734 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
16735 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
16736 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
16737 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
16738 caused by a denial of service attack.
16739
16740 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
16741 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
16742 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
16743 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
16744 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
16745 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
16746 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
16747 denial of service attack.
16748
16749 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
16750 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
16751 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
16752 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
16753 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
16754 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
16755 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
16756 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
16757 processed than on other servers.
16758
16759 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
16760 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
16761 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
16762 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
16763 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
16764 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
16765 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
16766 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
16767 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
16768 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
16769 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
16770 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
16771 should not be attributed to the logged server.
16772
16773 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16774 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
16775 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
16776 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
16777 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
16778 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016779 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016780 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
16781
16782 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
16783 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
16784 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
16785 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
16786 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
16787 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016788 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016789 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
16790 occurs.
16791
16792 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
16793 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
16794 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
16795 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
16796 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
16797 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
16798 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
16799 cookies" below for more details.
16800
16801 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
16802 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
16803 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
16804 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
16805 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
16806 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
16807 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
16808 and cookies" below for more details.
16809
16810 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
16811 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
16812 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
16813 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
16814 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
16815 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
16816 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
16817 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
16818
16819
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200168208.2.4. Custom log format
16821------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016822
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016823The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016824mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016825
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016826HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016827Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
16828separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
16829prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
16830
16831Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
16832variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016833("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016834
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016835If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020016836as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010016837less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
16838the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
16839
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016840Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016841In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010016842in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016843
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016844Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
16845'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
16846https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
16847such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
16848
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016849Flags are :
16850 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016851 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016852 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
16853 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016854
16855 Example:
16856
16857 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
16858 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
16859
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010016860 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
16861
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016862At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
16863
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016864 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
16865 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016866
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016867the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016868
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016869 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
16870 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
16871 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016872
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016873and the default TCP format is defined this way :
16874
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016875 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
16876 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016877
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016878Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
16879
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016880 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016881 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016882 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
16883 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
16884 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016885 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
16886 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
16887 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016888 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016889 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
16890 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000016891 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000016892 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
16893 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010016894 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020016895 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016896 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016897 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016898 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020016899 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080016900 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016901 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
16902 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
16903 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
16904 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
16905 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016906 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016907 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
16908 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016909 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016910 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
16911 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016912 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16913 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
16914 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016915 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016916 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
16917 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016918 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016919 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
16920 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
16921 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020016922 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020016923 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016924 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
16925 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
16926 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
16927 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020016928 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020016929 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016930 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016931 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010016932 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016933 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016934 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
16935 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
16936 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016937 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016938 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
16939 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010016940 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020016941 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
16942 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020016943 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016944 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016945 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010016946 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016947
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020016948 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010016949
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016950
169518.2.5. Error log format
16952-----------------------
16953
16954When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
16955protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
16956By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
16957"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016958will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010016959logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
16960
16961The format looks like this :
16962
16963 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
16964 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
16965 Connection error during SSL handshake
16966
16967 Field Format Extract from the example above
16968 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
16969 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
16970 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
16971 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
16972 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
16973
16974These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
16975failures.
16976
16977
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169788.3. Advanced logging options
16979-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016980
16981Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
16982just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
16983options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
16984for more information about their usage.
16985
16986
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200169878.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
16988------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016989
16990It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
16991haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
16992commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
16993monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
16994ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
16995
16996 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
16997 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
16998 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
16999 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
17000
17001 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
17002 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
17003 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017004 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017005 such as other load-balancers.
17006
17007 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
17008 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
17009 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
17010
17011
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170128.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
17013----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017014
17015The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
17016what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
17017or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017018"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017019just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
17020log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
17021after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
17022is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
17023with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
17024with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
17025
17026
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170278.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
17028------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017029
17030Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
17031for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
17032"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
17033retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
17034raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
17035a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
17036file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
17037you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
17038"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
17039
17040
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170418.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
17042--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020017043
17044Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
17045multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
17046them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
17047"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
17048logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
17049error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
17050and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
17051too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
17052useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
17053alternative.
17054
17055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170568.4. Timing events
17057------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017058
17059Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
17060reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
17061the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
17062frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017063mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
17064addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
17065
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010017066Timings events in HTTP mode:
17067
17068 first request 2nd request
17069 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
17070 t tr t tr ...
17071 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
17072 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
17073 :<---- Tq ---->: :
17074 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
17075 :<--------- Ta --------->:
17076
17077Timings events in TCP mode:
17078
17079 TCP session
17080 |<----------------->|
17081 t t
17082 ---|----|----|----|----|---
17083 | Th Tw Tc Td |
17084 |<------ Tt ------->|
17085
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017086 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017087 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017088 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
17089 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
17090 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017091 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017092 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
17093 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
17094 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
17095 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017096
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017097 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
17098 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
17099 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020017100 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
17101 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
17102 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
17103 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
17104 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
17105 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017106
17107 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
17108 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
17109 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
17110 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
17111 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
17112 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
17113 request typed by hand during a test.
17114
17115 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
17116 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017117 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017118 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
17119 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
17120 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
17121 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017122
17123 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
17124 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
17125 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
17126 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
17127 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
17128
17129 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
17130 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
17131 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
17132 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
17133 connection never established.
17134
17135 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
17136 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
17137 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
17138 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
17139 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
17140 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
17141 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
17142 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
17143 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
17144 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
17145 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
17146
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017147 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
17148 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
17149 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
17150 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
17151 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
17152 by subtracting other timers when valid :
17153
17154 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
17155
17156 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
17157 "Ta" can never be negative.
17158
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017159 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
17160 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017161 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
17162 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017163 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017164
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017165 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017166
17167 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017168 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
17169 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017170
17171These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
17172protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
17173that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017174due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
17175"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
17176that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017177
17178Most common cases :
17179
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017180 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
17181 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
17182 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
17183 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
17184 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
17185 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
17186 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
17187 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
17188 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
17189 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
17190 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020017191 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017192
17193 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
17194 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
17195 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
17196 of ms on remote networks.
17197
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017198 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
17199 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
17200 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017201
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017202 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
17203 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
17204 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
17205 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
17206 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
17207 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
17208 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
17209 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
17210 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017211
17212Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
17213
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017214 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017215 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017216 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017217
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017218 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017219 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
17220 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
17221
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017222 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017223 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
17224 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
17225 flags.
17226
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017227 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
17228 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017229 Check the session termination flags, then check the
17230 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
17231 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
17232 the client connection was maintained open.
17233
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017234 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017235 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020017236 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017237 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
17238
17239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172408.5. Session state at disconnection
17241-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017242
17243TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
17244"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
172452-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
17246each of which has a special meaning :
17247
17248 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
17249 session to terminate :
17250
17251 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
17252
17253 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
17254 server explicitly refused it.
17255
17256 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
17257 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
17258 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
17259 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017260 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017261
17262 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
17263 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017264
17265 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
17266 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
17267 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
17268 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
17269 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
17270
17271 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
17272 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
17273 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
17274 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
17275 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
17276
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090017277 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
17278 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
17279
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070017280 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
17281 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
17282 backup connections when going up.
17283
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020017284 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
17285
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017286 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
17287 send or receive data.
17288
17289 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
17290 send or receive data.
17291
17292 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
17293 with nothing left in the buffers.
17294
17295 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
17296
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010017297 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017298 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
17299
17300 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
17301 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
17302 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
17303 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
17304 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
17305
17306 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
17307 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
17308
17309 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
17310 server (HTTP only).
17311
17312 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
17313
17314 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
17315 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
17316 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
17317
17318 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
17319 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
17320 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
17321
17322 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
17323
17324 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
17325 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
17326
17327 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
17328 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
17329 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
17330
17331 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
17332 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020017333 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
17334 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017335
17336 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
17337 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
17338 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
17339 another server.
17340
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017341 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017342 server.
17343
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017344 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
17345 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
17346 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
17347 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17348
17349 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
17350 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
17351 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
17352 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
17353
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020017354 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
17355 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
17356 "use-server" rule).
17357
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017358 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17359
17360 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
17361 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
17362
17363 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
17364
17365 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
17366 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
17367 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
17368
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017369 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
17370 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017371 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017372 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
17373 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
17374
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017375 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
17376
17377 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
17378 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
17379
17380 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
17381
17382 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
17383
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017384The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
17385was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017386helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
17387starvation, attacks, etc...
17388
17389The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
17390alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
17391easier finding and understanding.
17392
17393 Flags Reason
17394
17395 -- Normal termination.
17396
17397 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
17398 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
17399 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
17400 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
17401
17402 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
17403 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
17404 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
17405 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
17406 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
17407 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017408
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017409 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17410 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017411 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017412
17413 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
17414 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
17415 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
17416
17417 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
17418 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
17419 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
17420 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
17421 the server takes too long to respond.
17422
17423 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
17424 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
17425 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
17426 long a time to respond.
17427
17428 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
17429 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
17430 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
17431 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017432 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
17433 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017434
17435 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
17436 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
17437 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
17438 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
17439 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020017440 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017441 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
17442 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
17443 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
17444 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
17445 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
17446 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
17447 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
17448 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017449 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020017450 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
17451 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
17452 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017453
17454 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
17455 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017456 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
17457 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
17458 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
17459 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017460
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020017461 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
17462 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
17463
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017464 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017465 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
17466 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017467 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017468 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
17469 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
17470
17471 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
17472 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
17473 503 or 504 here.
17474
17475 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
17476 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
17477 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
17478 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
17479 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
17480
17481 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
17482 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017483 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017484 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
17485 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
17486
17487 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
17488 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
17489 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
17490 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
17491 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
17492 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
17493 between haproxy and the server.
17494
17495 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
17496 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
17497 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
17498 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
17499 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
17500 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
17501 solution is to fix the application.
17502
17503 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
17504 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
17505 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
17506 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
17507 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
17508 external attacks.
17509
17510 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
17511 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020017512 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017513 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
17514 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
17515
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017516 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
17517 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
17518 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017519 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020017520 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017521
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017522 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
17523 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
17524 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
17525 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010017526 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
17527 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
17528 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
17529 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
17530 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017531
17532 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
17533 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
17534 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
17535 returned an HTTP 403 error.
17536
17537 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
17538 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
17539 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
17540 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
17541
17542 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
17543 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
17544 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
17545 only be solved by proper system tuning.
17546
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017547The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
17548persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
17549important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
17550re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
17551
17552 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
17553
17554 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17555 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
17556 set on a GET request.
17557
17558 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
17559 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017560 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020017561 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
17562
17563 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
17564 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
17565 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
17566
17567 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
17568 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
17569 already got a cookie.
17570
17571 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17572 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
17573 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
17574 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
17575 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
17576
17577 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
17578 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17579 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17580
17581 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
17582 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
17583 new cookie was inserted in the response.
17584
17585 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
17586 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
17587
17588 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
17589 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
17590 then advertised in the response.
17591
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200175938.6. Non-printable characters
17594-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017595
17596In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
17597consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
17598converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
17599prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
17600being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
17601escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
17602is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
17603'}' when logging headers.
17604
17605Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
17606issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
17607containing spaces is "User-Agent".
17608
17609Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
17610the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
17611performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
17612
17613
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176148.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
17615---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017616
17617Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
17618achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017619section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017620cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
17621the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
17622the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017623locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017624not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
17625user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
17626a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
17627wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
17628
17629 Examples :
17630 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
17631 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
17632
17633 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
17634 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
17635
17636
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176378.8. Capturing HTTP headers
17638---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017639
17640Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
17641proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
17642the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
17643server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
17644
17645Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
17646response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017647section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017648
17649It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017650time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
17651appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017652are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
17653and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
17654follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
17655request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
17656in the logs.
17657
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020017658As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
17659frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
17660an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
17661
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017662 Example :
17663 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
17664 listen proxy-out
17665 mode http
17666 option httplog
17667 option logasap
17668 log global
17669 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
17670
17671 # log the name of the virtual server
17672 capture request header Host len 20
17673
17674 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
17675 capture request header Content-Length len 10
17676
17677 # log the beginning of the referrer
17678 capture request header Referer len 20
17679
17680 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
17681 capture response header Server len 20
17682
17683 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
17684 capture response header Content-Length len 10
17685
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017686 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017687 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
17688
17689 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
17690 capture response header Via len 20
17691
17692 # log the URL location during a redirection
17693 capture response header Location len 20
17694
17695 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
17696 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
17697 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17698 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
17699 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
17700
17701 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17702 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17703 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17704 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017705 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017706
17707 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
17708 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
17709 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
17710 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
17711 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017712 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017713
17714
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177158.9. Examples of logs
17716---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017717
17718These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
17719them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
17720reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
17721
17722 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
17723 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17724 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17725
17726 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
17727 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
17728
17729 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
17730 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
17731 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
17732
17733 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
17734 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
17735
17736 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
17737 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
17738 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
17739
17740 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010017741 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017742 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
17743 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
17744
17745 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
17746 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
17747 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
17748
17749 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
17750 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020017751 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017752 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
17753 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
17754 to return the 502 and not the server.
17755
17756 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017757 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017758
17759 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
17760 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
17761 Nothing was sent to any server.
17762
17763 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
17764 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
17765
17766 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
17767 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017768 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017769 send a 408 return code to the client.
17770
17771 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
17772 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
17773
17774 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
17775 5 seconds ("c----").
17776
17777 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
17778 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017779 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017780
17781 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017782 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010017783 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
17784 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
17785 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
17786 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
17787 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010017788
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020017789
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200177909. Supported filters
17791--------------------
17792
17793Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
17794accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
17795unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
17796
17797See also : "filter"
17798
177999.1. Trace
17800----------
17801
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017802filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017803
17804 Arguments:
17805 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
17806 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
17807
17808 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
17809 the client and the server. By default, this filter
17810 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
17811 only parses a random amount of the available data.
17812
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017813 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017814 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
17815 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
17816 amount of the parsed data.
17817
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017818 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010017819
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017820This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
17821callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
17822information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
17823filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
17824
17825Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
17826tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
17827a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
17828
17829
178309.2. HTTP compression
17831---------------------
17832
17833filter compression
17834
17835The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
17836keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017837when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache enabled,
17838it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always done after the
17839response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter
17840line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one filter other than the
17841cache is used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know
17842the filters evaluation order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017843
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017844See also : "compression" and section 9.4 about the cache filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020017845
17846
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200178479.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
17848--------------------------------------------
17849
17850filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
17851
17852 Arguments :
17853
17854 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
17855 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
17856 parsed.
17857
17858 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
17859 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
17860 part must be placed in its own scope.
17861
17862The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
17863external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017864streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017865exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
17866also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
17867
17868SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
17869the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
17870
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017871For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020017872"doc/SPOE.txt".
17873
17874Important note:
17875 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
17876 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
17877
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100178789.4. Cache
17879----------
17880
17881filter cache <name>
17882
17883 Arguments :
17884
17885 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
17886
17887The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
17888"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
17889cache. By default the correpsonding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017890other filters than cache or compression are used, it is enough. In such case,
17891the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it is
17892mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
17893filter other than the compression is used for the same
17894listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
17895order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017896
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010017897See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter and section 10 about cache.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017898
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01001789910. Cache
17900---------
17901
17902HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17903(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17904RAM.
17905
17906The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017907this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017908
17909If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17910independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17911when we try to allocate a new one.
17912
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +010017913The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017914
17915It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17916"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17917for more details.
17918
17919When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17920replaced by "<CACHE>".
17921
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001792210.1. Limitation
17923----------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017924
17925The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17926
17927- If the response is not a 200
17928- If the response contains a Vary header
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017929- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017930- If the response is not cacheable
17931
17932- If the request is not a GET
17933- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
William Lallemand8a16fe02018-05-22 11:04:33 +020017934- If the request contains an Authorization header
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017935
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010017936Caution!: For HAProxy version prior to 1.9, due to the limitation of the
17937filters, it is not recommended to use the cache with other filters. Using them
17938can cause undefined behavior if they modify the response (compression for
17939example). For HAProxy 1.9 and greater, it is safe, for HTX proxies only (see
17940"option http-use-htx" for details).
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017941
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001794210.2. Setup
17943-----------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017944
17945To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17946the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17947
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001794810.2.1. Cache section
17949---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017950
17951cache <name>
17952 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17953 size of cache is mandatory.
17954
17955total-max-size <megabytes>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017956 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017957 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017958
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017959max-object-size <bytes>
Frédéric Lécaillee3c83d82018-10-25 10:46:40 +020017960 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17961 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17962 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
Frédéric Lécaille5f8bea62018-10-23 10:09:19 +020017963
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017964max-age <seconds>
17965 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
17966 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17967 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17968 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17969 default.
17970
Cyril Bonté7b888f12017-11-26 22:24:31 +01001797110.2.2. Proxy section
17972---------------------
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017973
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017974http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017975 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17976 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17977 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17978 after this one.
17979
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +020017980http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010017981 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17982 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17983 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17984 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17985
17986
17987Example:
17988
17989 backend bck1
17990 mode http
17991
17992 http-request cache-use foobar
17993 http-response cache-store foobar
17994 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17995
17996 cache foobar
17997 total-max-size 4
17998 max-age 240
17999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018000/*
18001 * Local variables:
18002 * fill-column: 79
18003 * End:
18004 */